Movatterモバイル変換


[0]ホーム

URL:


[RFC Home] [TEXT|PDF|HTML] [Tracker] [IPR] [Errata] [Info page]

Obsoleted by:3530 PROPOSED STANDARD
Errata Exist
Network Working Group                                         S. SheplerRequest for Comments: 3010                                  B. CallaghanObsoletes:1813,1094                                        D. RobinsonCategory: Standards Track                                     R. Thurlow                                                   Sun Microsystems Inc.                                                                C. Beame                                                        Hummingbird Ltd.                                                               M. Eisler                                                           Zambeel, Inc.                                                               D. Noveck                                                 Network Appliance, Inc.                                                           December 2000NFS version 4 ProtocolStatus of this Memo   This document specifies an Internet standards track protocol for the   Internet community, and requests discussion and suggestions for   improvements.  Please refer to the current edition of the "Internet   Official Protocol Standards" (STD 1) for the standardization state   and status of this protocol.  Distribution of this memo is unlimited.Copyright Notice   Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2000).  All Rights Reserved.Abstract   NFS (Network File System) version 4 is a distributed file system   protocol which owes heritage to NFS protocol versions 2 [RFC1094] and   3 [RFC1813].  Unlike earlier versions, the NFS version 4 protocol   supports traditional file access while integrating support for file   locking and the mount protocol.  In addition, support for strong   security (and its negotiation), compound operations, client caching,   and internationalization have been added.  Of course, attention has   been applied to making NFS version 4 operate well in an Internet   environment.Key Words   The key words "MUST", "MUST NOT", "REQUIRED", "SHALL", "SHALL NOT",   "SHOULD", "SHOULD NOT", "RECOMMENDED", "MAY", and "OPTIONAL" in this   document are to be interpreted as described inRFC 2119.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 1]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000Table of Contents1.  Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51.1.  Overview of NFS Version 4 Features . . . . . . . . . . . .61.1.1.  RPC and Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61.1.2.  Procedure and Operation Structure  . . . . . . . . . . .71.1.3.  File System Model  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81.1.3.1.  Filehandle Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81.1.3.2.  Attribute Types  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81.1.3.3.  File System Replication and Migration  . . . . . . . .91.1.4.  OPEN and CLOSE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91.1.5.  File locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91.1.6.  Client Caching and Delegation  . . . . . . . . . . . . .101.2.  General Definitions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112.  Protocol Data Types  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122.1.  Basic Data Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122.2.  Structured Data Types  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143.  RPC and Security Flavor  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183.1.  Ports and Transports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183.2.  Security Flavors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183.2.1.  Security mechanisms for NFS version 4  . . . . . . . . .193.2.1.1.  Kerberos V5 as security triple . . . . . . . . . . . .193.2.1.2.  LIPKEY as a security triple  . . . . . . . . . . . . .193.2.1.3.  SPKM-3 as a security triple  . . . . . . . . . . . . .203.3.  Security Negotiation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213.3.1.  Security Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213.3.2.  SECINFO  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213.4.  Callback RPC Authentication  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224.  Filehandles  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234.1.  Obtaining the First Filehandle . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244.1.1.  Root Filehandle  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244.1.2.  Public Filehandle  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244.2.  Filehandle Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254.2.1.  General Properties of a Filehandle . . . . . . . . . . .254.2.2.  Persistent Filehandle  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264.2.3.  Volatile Filehandle  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264.2.4.  One Method of Constructing a Volatile Filehandle . . . .284.3.  Client Recovery from Filehandle Expiration . . . . . . . .285.  File Attributes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295.1.  Mandatory Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305.2.  Recommended Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305.3.  Named Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315.4.  Mandatory Attributes - Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . .315.5.  Recommended Attributes - Definitions . . . . . . . . . . .335.6.  Interpreting owner and owner_group . . . . . . . . . . . .385.7.  Character Case Attributes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395.8.  Quota Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395.9.  Access Control Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 2]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20005.9.1.  ACE type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415.9.2.  ACE flag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415.9.3.  ACE Access Mask  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435.9.4.  ACE who  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .446.  File System Migration and Replication  . . . . . . . . . . .446.1.  Replication  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .456.2.  Migration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .456.3.  Interpretation of the fs_locations Attribute . . . . . . .466.4.  Filehandle Recovery for Migration or Replication . . . . .477.  NFS Server Name Space  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .477.1.  Server Exports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .477.2.  Browsing Exports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487.3.  Server Pseudo File System  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487.4.  Multiple Roots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .497.5.  Filehandle Volatility  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .497.6.  Exported Root  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .497.7.  Mount Point Crossing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .497.8.  Security Policy and Name Space Presentation  . . . . . . .508.  File Locking and Share Reservations  . . . . . . . . . . . .508.1.  Locking  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .518.1.1.  Client ID  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .518.1.2.  Server Release of Clientid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .538.1.3.  nfs_lockowner and stateid Definition . . . . . . . . . .548.1.4.  Use of the stateid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .558.1.5.  Sequencing of Lock Requests  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .568.1.6.  Recovery from Replayed Requests  . . . . . . . . . . . .568.1.7.  Releasing nfs_lockowner State  . . . . . . . . . . . . .578.2.  Lock Ranges  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .578.3.  Blocking Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .588.4.  Lease Renewal  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .588.5.  Crash Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .598.5.1.  Client Failure and Recovery  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .598.5.2.  Server Failure and Recovery  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .608.5.3.  Network Partitions and Recovery  . . . . . . . . . . . .628.6.  Recovery from a Lock Request Timeout or Abort  . . . . . .638.7.  Server Revocation of Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .638.8.  Share Reservations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .658.9.  OPEN/CLOSE Operations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .658.10.  Open Upgrade and Downgrade  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .668.11.  Short and Long Leases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .668.12.  Clocks and Calculating Lease Expiration . . . . . . . . .678.13.  Migration, Replication and State  . . . . . . . . . . . .678.13.1.  Migration and State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .678.13.2.  Replication and State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .688.13.3.  Notification of Migrated Lease  . . . . . . . . . . . .699.  Client-Side Caching  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .699.1.  Performance Challenges for Client-Side Caching . . . . . .709.2.  Delegation and Callbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 3]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20009.2.1.  Delegation Recovery  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .729.3.  Data Caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .749.3.1.  Data Caching and OPENs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .749.3.2.  Data Caching and File Locking  . . . . . . . . . . . . .759.3.3.  Data Caching and Mandatory File Locking  . . . . . . . .779.3.4.  Data Caching and File Identity . . . . . . . . . . . . .779.4.  Open Delegation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .789.4.1.  Open Delegation and Data Caching . . . . . . . . . . . .809.4.2.  Open Delegation and File Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . .829.4.3.  Recall of Open Delegation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .829.4.4.  Delegation Revocation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .849.5.  Data Caching and Revocation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .849.5.1.  Revocation Recovery for Write Open Delegation  . . . . .859.6.  Attribute Caching  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .859.7.  Name Caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .869.8.  Directory Caching  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8710.  Minor Versioning  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8811.  Internationalization  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9111.1.  Universal Versus Local Character Sets . . . . . . . . . .9111.2.  Overview of Universal Character Set Standards . . . . . .9211.3.  Difficulties with UCS-4, UCS-2, Unicode . . . . . . . . .9311.4.  UTF-8 and its solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9411.5.  Normalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9412.  Error Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9513.  NFS Version 4 Requests  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9913.1.  Compound Procedure  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10013.2.  Evaluation of a Compound Request  . . . . . . . . . . . .10013.3.  Synchronous Modifying Operations  . . . . . . . . . . . .10113.4.  Operation Values  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10214.  NFS Version 4 Procedures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10214.1.  Procedure 0: NULL - No Operation  . . . . . . . . . . . .10214.2.  Procedure 1: COMPOUND - Compound Operations . . . . . . .10214.2.1.  Operation 3: ACCESS - Check Access Rights . . . . . . .10514.2.2.  Operation 4: CLOSE - Close File . . . . . . . . . . . .10814.2.3.  Operation 5: COMMIT - Commit Cached Data  . . . . . . .109   14.2.4.  Operation 6: CREATE - Create a Non-Regular File Object. 112   14.2.5.  Operation 7: DELEGPURGE - Purge Delegations Awaiting            Recovery  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11414.2.6.  Operation 8: DELEGRETURN - Return Delegation  . . . . .11514.2.7.  Operation 9: GETATTR - Get Attributes . . . . . . . . .11514.2.8.  Operation 10: GETFH - Get Current Filehandle  . . . . .11714.2.9.  Operation 11: LINK - Create Link to a File  . . . . . .11814.2.10.  Operation 12: LOCK - Create Lock . . . . . . . . . . .11914.2.11.  Operation 13: LOCKT - Test For Lock  . . . . . . . . .12114.2.12.  Operation 14: LOCKU - Unlock File  . . . . . . . . . .12214.2.13.  Operation 15: LOOKUP - Lookup Filename . . . . . . . .12314.2.14.  Operation 16: LOOKUPP - Lookup Parent Directory  . . .126Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 4]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   14.2.15.  Operation 17: NVERIFY - Verify Difference in             Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12714.2.16.  Operation 18: OPEN - Open a Regular File . . . . . . .128   14.2.17.  Operation 19: OPENATTR - Open Named Attribute             Directory  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13714.2.18.  Operation 20: OPEN_CONFIRM - Confirm Open  . . . . . .138   14.2.19.  Operation 21: OPEN_DOWNGRADE - Reduce Open File Access 14014.2.20.  Operation 22: PUTFH - Set Current Filehandle . . . . .14114.2.21.  Operation 23: PUTPUBFH - Set Public Filehandle . . . .14214.2.22.  Operation 24: PUTROOTFH - Set Root Filehandle  . . . .14314.2.23.  Operation 25: READ - Read from File  . . . . . . . . .14414.2.24.  Operation 26: READDIR - Read Directory . . . . . . . .14614.2.25.  Operation 27: READLINK - Read Symbolic Link  . . . . .15014.2.26.  Operation 28: REMOVE - Remove Filesystem Object  . . .15114.2.27.  Operation 29: RENAME - Rename Directory Entry  . . . .15314.2.28.  Operation 30: RENEW - Renew a Lease  . . . . . . . . .15514.2.29.  Operation 31: RESTOREFH - Restore Saved Filehandle . .15614.2.30.  Operation 32: SAVEFH - Save Current Filehandle . . . .15714.2.31.  Operation 33: SECINFO - Obtain Available Security  . .15814.2.32.  Operation 34: SETATTR - Set Attributes . . . . . . . .16014.2.33.  Operation 35: SETCLIENTID - Negotiate Clientid . . . .162   14.2.34.  Operation 36: SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM - Confirm Clientid . 16314.2.35.  Operation 37: VERIFY - Verify Same Attributes  . . . .16414.2.36.  Operation 38: WRITE - Write to File  . . . . . . . . .16615.  NFS Version 4 Callback Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . .17015.1.  Procedure 0: CB_NULL - No Operation . . . . . . . . . . .17015.2.  Procedure 1: CB_COMPOUND - Compound Operations  . . . . .17115.2.1.  Operation 3: CB_GETATTR - Get Attributes  . . . . . . .17215.2.2.  Operation 4: CB_RECALL - Recall an Open Delegation  . .17316.  Security Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17417.  IANA Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17417.1.  Named Attribute Definition  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17418.  RPC definition file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17519.  Bibliography  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20620.  Authors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21020.1.  Editor's Address  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21020.2.  Authors' Addresses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21020.3.  Acknowledgements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21121.  Full Copyright Statement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2121.  Introduction   The NFS version 4 protocol is a further revision of the NFS protocol   defined already by versions 2 [RFC1094] and 3 [RFC1813].  It retains   the essential characteristics of previous versions: design for easy   recovery, independent of transport protocols, operating systems and   filesystems, simplicity, and good performance.  The NFS version 4   revision has the following goals:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 5]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  Improved access and good performance on the Internet.      The protocol is designed to transit firewalls easily, perform well      where latency is high and bandwidth is low, and scale to very      large numbers of clients per server.   o  Strong security with negotiation built into the protocol.      The protocol builds on the work of the ONCRPC working group in      supporting the RPCSEC_GSS protocol.  Additionally, the NFS version      4 protocol provides a mechanism to allow clients and servers the      ability to negotiate security and require clients and servers to      support a minimal set of security schemes.   o  Good cross-platform interoperability.      The protocol features a file system model that provides a useful,      common set of features that does not unduly favor one file system      or operating system over another.   o  Designed for protocol extensions.      The protocol is designed to accept standard extensions that do not      compromise backward compatibility.1.1.  Overview of NFS Version 4 Features   To provide a reasonable context for the reader, the major features of   NFS version 4 protocol will be reviewed in brief.  This will be done   to provide an appropriate context for both the reader who is familiar   with the previous versions of the NFS protocol and the reader that is   new to the NFS protocols.  For the reader new to the NFS protocols,   there is still a fundamental knowledge that is expected.  The reader   should be familiar with the XDR and RPC protocols as described in   [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  A basic knowledge of file systems and   distributed file systems is expected as well.1.1.1.  RPC and Security   As with previous versions of NFS, the External Data Representation   (XDR) and Remote Procedure Call (RPC) mechanisms used for the NFS   version 4 protocol are those defined in [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  To   meet end to end security requirements, the RPCSEC_GSS framework   [RFC2203] will be used to extend the basic RPC security.  With the   use of RPCSEC_GSS, various mechanisms can be provided to offer   authentication, integrity, and privacy to the NFS version 4 protocol.   Kerberos V5 will be used as described in [RFC1964] to provide one   security framework.  The LIPKEY GSS-API mechanism described inShepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 6]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   [RFC2847] will be used to provide for the use of user password and   server public key by the NFS version 4 protocol.  With the use of   RPCSEC_GSS, other mechanisms may also be specified and used for NFS   version 4 security.   To enable in-band security negotiation, the NFS version 4 protocol   has added a new operation which provides the client a method of   querying the server about its policies regarding which security   mechanisms must be used for access to the server's file system   resources.  With this, the client can securely match the security   mechanism that meets the policies specified at both the client and   server.1.1.2.  Procedure and Operation Structure   A significant departure from the previous versions of the NFS   protocol is the introduction of the COMPOUND procedure.  For the NFS   version 4 protocol, there are two RPC procedures, NULL and COMPOUND.   The COMPOUND procedure is defined in terms of operations and these   operations correspond more closely to the traditional NFS procedures.   With the use of the COMPOUND procedure, the client is able to build   simple or complex requests.  These COMPOUND requests allow for a   reduction in the number of RPCs needed for logical file system   operations.  For example, without previous contact with a server a   client will be able to read data from a file in one request by   combining LOOKUP, OPEN, and READ operations in a single COMPOUND RPC.   With previous versions of the NFS protocol, this type of single   request was not possible.   The model used for COMPOUND is very simple.  There is no logical OR   or ANDing of operations.  The operations combined within a COMPOUND   request are evaluated in order by the server.  Once an operation   returns a failing result, the evaluation ends and the results of all   evaluated operations are returned to the client.   The NFS version 4 protocol continues to have the client refer to a   file or directory at the server by a "filehandle".  The COMPOUND   procedure has a method of passing a filehandle from one operation to   another within the sequence of operations.  There is a concept of a   "current filehandle" and "saved filehandle".  Most operations use the   "current filehandle" as the file system object to operate upon.  The   "saved filehandle" is used as temporary filehandle storage within a   COMPOUND procedure as well as an additional operand for certain   operations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 7]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20001.1.3.  File System Model   The general file system model used for the NFS version 4 protocol is   the same as previous versions.  The server file system is   hierarchical with the regular files contained within being treated as   opaque byte streams.  In a slight departure, file and directory names   are encoded with UTF-8 to deal with the basics of   internationalization.   The NFS version 4 protocol does not require a separate protocol to   provide for the initial mapping between path name and filehandle.   Instead of using the older MOUNT protocol for this mapping, the   server provides a ROOT filehandle that represents the logical root or   top of the file system tree provided by the server.  The server   provides multiple file systems by gluing them together with pseudo   file systems.  These pseudo file systems provide for potential gaps   in the path names between real file systems.1.1.3.1.  Filehandle Types   In previous versions of the NFS protocol, the filehandle provided by   the server was guaranteed to be valid or persistent for the lifetime   of the file system object to which it referred.  For some server   implementations, this persistence requirement has been difficult to   meet.  For the NFS version 4 protocol, this requirement has been   relaxed by introducing another type of filehandle, volatile.  With   persistent and volatile filehandle types, the server implementation   can match the abilities of the file system at the server along with   the operating environment.  The client will have knowledge of the   type of filehandle being provided by the server and can be prepared   to deal with the semantics of each.1.1.3.2.  Attribute Types   The NFS version 4 protocol introduces three classes of file system or   file attributes.  Like the additional filehandle type, the   classification of file attributes has been done to ease server   implementations along with extending the overall functionality of the   NFS protocol.  This attribute model is structured to be extensible   such that new attributes can be introduced in minor revisions of the   protocol without requiring significant rework.   The three classifications are: mandatory, recommended and named   attributes.  This is a significant departure from the previous   attribute model used in the NFS protocol.  Previously, the attributes   for the file system and file objects were a fixed set of mainly Unix   attributes.  If the server or client did not support a particular   attribute, it would have to simulate the attribute the best it could.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 8]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   Mandatory attributes are the minimal set of file or file system   attributes that must be provided by the server and must be properly   represented by the server.  Recommended attributes represent   different file system types and operating environments.  The   recommended attributes will allow for better interoperability and the   inclusion of more operating environments.  The mandatory and   recommended attribute sets are traditional file or file system   attributes.  The third type of attribute is the named attribute.  A   named attribute is an opaque byte stream that is associated with a   directory or file and referred to by a string name.  Named attributes   are meant to be used by client applications as a method to associate   application specific data with a regular file or directory.   One significant addition to the recommended set of file attributes is   the Access Control List (ACL) attribute.  This attribute provides for   directory and file access control beyond the model used in previous   versions of the NFS protocol.  The ACL definition allows for   specification of user and group level access control.1.1.3.3.  File System Replication and Migration   With the use of a special file attribute, the ability to migrate or   replicate server file systems is enabled within the protocol.  The   file system locations attribute provides a method for the client to   probe the server about the location of a file system.  In the event   of a migration of a file system, the client will receive an error   when operating on the file system and it can then query as to the new   file system location.  Similar steps are used for replication, the   client is able to query the server for the multiple available   locations of a particular file system.  From this information, the   client can use its own policies to access the appropriate file system   location.1.1.4.  OPEN and CLOSE   The NFS version 4 protocol introduces OPEN and CLOSE operations.  The   OPEN operation provides a single point where file lookup, creation,   and share semantics can be combined.  The CLOSE operation also   provides for the release of state accumulated by OPEN.1.1.5.  File locking   With the NFS version 4 protocol, the support for byte range file   locking is part of the NFS protocol.  The file locking support is   structured so that an RPC callback mechanism is not required.  This   is a departure from the previous versions of the NFS file locking   protocol, Network Lock Manager (NLM).  The state associated with file   locks is maintained at the server under a lease-based model.  TheShepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 9]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   server defines a single lease period for all state held by a NFS   client.  If the client does not renew its lease within the defined   period, all state associated with the client's lease may be released   by the server.  The client may renew its lease with use of the RENEW   operation or implicitly by use of other operations (primarily READ).1.1.6.  Client Caching and Delegation   The file, attribute, and directory caching for the NFS version 4   protocol is similar to previous versions.  Attributes and directory   information are cached for a duration determined by the client.  At   the end of a predefined timeout, the client will query the server to   see if the related file system object has been updated.   For file data, the client checks its cache validity when the file is   opened.  A query is sent to the server to determine if the file has   been changed.  Based on this information, the client determines if   the data cache for the file should kept or released.  Also, when the   file is closed, any modified data is written to the server.   If an application wants to serialize access to file data, file   locking of the file data ranges in question should be used.   The major addition to NFS version 4 in the area of caching is the   ability of the server to delegate certain responsibilities to the   client.  When the server grants a delegation for a file to a client,   the client is guaranteed certain semantics with respect to the   sharing of that file with other clients.  At OPEN, the server may   provide the client either a read or write delegation for the file.   If the client is granted a read delegation, it is assured that no   other client has the ability to write to the file for the duration of   the delegation.  If the client is granted a write delegation, the   client is assured that no other client has read or write access to   the file.   Delegations can be recalled by the server.  If another client   requests access to the file in such a way that the access conflicts   with the granted delegation, the server is able to notify the initial   client and recall the delegation.  This requires that a callback path   exist between the server and client.  If this callback path does not   exist, then delegations can not be granted.  The essence of a   delegation is that it allows the client to locally service operations   such as OPEN, CLOSE, LOCK, LOCKU, READ, WRITE without immediate   interaction with the server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 10]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20001.2.  General Definitions   The following definitions are provided for the purpose of providing   an appropriate context for the reader.   Client    The "client" is the entity that accesses the NFS server's             resources.  The client may be an application which contains             the logic to access the NFS server directly.  The client             may also be the traditional operating system client remote             file system services for a set of applications.             In the case of file locking the client is the entity that             maintains a set of locks on behalf of one or more             applications.  This client is responsible for crash or             failure recovery for those locks it manages.             Note that multiple clients may share the same transport and             multiple clients may exist on the same network node.   Clientid  A 64-bit quantity used as a unique, short-hand reference to             a client supplied Verifier and ID.  The server is             responsible for supplying the Clientid.   Lease     An interval of time defined by the server for which the             client is irrevocably granted a lock.  At the end of a             lease period the lock may be revoked if the lease has not             been extended.  The lock must be revoked if a conflicting             lock has been granted after the lease interval.             All leases granted by a server have the same fixed             interval.  Note that the fixed interval was chosen to             alleviate the expense a server would have in maintaining             state about variable length leases across server failures.   Lock      The term "lock" is used to refer to both record (byte-             range) locks as well as file (share) locks unless             specifically stated otherwise.   Server    The "Server" is the entity responsible for coordinating             client access to a set of file systems.   Stable Storage             NFS version 4 servers must be able to recover without data             loss from multiple power failures (including cascading             power failures, that is, several power failures in quick             succession), operating system failures, and hardware             failure of components other than the storage medium itself             (for example, disk, nonvolatile RAM).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 11]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000             Some examples of stable storage that are allowable for an             NFS server include:             1. Media commit of data, that is, the modified data has                been successfully written to the disk media, for                example, the disk platter.             2. An immediate reply disk drive with battery-backed on-                drive intermediate storage or uninterruptible power                system (UPS).             3. Server commit of data with battery-backed intermediate                storage and recovery software.             4. Cache commit with uninterruptible power system (UPS) and                recovery software.   Stateid   A 64-bit quantity returned by a server that uniquely             defines the locking state granted by the server for a             specific lock owner for a specific file.             Stateids composed of all bits 0 or all bits 1 have special             meaning and are reserved values.   Verifier  A 64-bit quantity generated by the client that the server             can use to determine if the client has restarted and lost             all previous lock state.2.  Protocol Data Types   The syntax and semantics to describe the data types of the NFS   version 4 protocol are defined in the XDR [RFC1832] and RPC [RFC1831]   documents.  The next sections build upon the XDR data types to define   types and structures specific to this protocol.2.1.  Basic Data Types   Data Type     Definition   _____________________________________________________________________   int32_t       typedef int             int32_t;   uint32_t      typedef unsigned int    uint32_t;   int64_t       typedef hyper           int64_t;   uint64_t      typedef unsigned hyper  uint64_t;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 12]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   attrlist4     typedef opaque        attrlist4<>;                 Used for file/directory attributes   bitmap4       typedef uint32_t        bitmap4<>;                 Used in attribute array encoding.   changeid4     typedef       uint64_t        changeid4;                 Used in definition of change_info   clientid4     typedef uint64_t        clientid4;                 Shorthand reference to client identification   component4    typedef utf8string      component4;                 Represents path name components   count4        typedef uint32_t        count4;                 Various count parameters (READ, WRITE, COMMIT)   length4       typedef uint64_t        length4;                 Describes LOCK lengths   linktext4     typedef utf8string      linktext4;                 Symbolic link contents   mode4         typedef uint32_t        mode4;                 Mode attribute data type   nfs_cookie4   typedef uint64_t        nfs_cookie4;                 Opaque cookie value for READDIR   nfs_fh4       typedef opaque          nfs_fh4<NFS4_FHSIZE>;                 Filehandle definition; NFS4_FHSIZE is defined as 128   nfs_ftype4    enum nfs_ftype4;                 Various defined file types   nfsstat4      enum nfsstat4;                 Return value for operations   offset4       typedef uint64_t        offset4;                 Various offset designations (READ, WRITE, LOCK, COMMIT)   pathname4     typedef component4      pathname4<>;                 Represents path name for LOOKUP, OPEN and others   qop4          typedef uint32_t        qop4;                 Quality of protection designation in SECINFOShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 13]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   sec_oid4      typedef opaque          sec_oid4<>;                 Security Object Identifier                 The sec_oid4 data type is not really opaque.                 Instead contains an ASN.1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER as used                 by GSS-API in the mech_type argument to                 GSS_Init_sec_context.  See [RFC2078] for details.   seqid4        typedef uint32_t        seqid4;                 Sequence identifier used for file locking   stateid4      typedef uint64_t        stateid4;                 State identifier used for file locking and delegation   utf8string    typedef opaque          utf8string<>;                 UTF-8 encoding for strings   verifier4     typedef opaque        verifier4[NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE];                 Verifier used for various operations (COMMIT, CREATE,                 OPEN, READDIR, SETCLIENTID, WRITE)                 NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE is defined as 82.2.  Structured Data Types   nfstime4                  struct nfstime4 {                          int64_t seconds;                          uint32_t nseconds;                  }      The nfstime4 structure gives the number of seconds and nanoseconds      since midnight or 0 hour January 1, 1970 Coordinated Universal      Time (UTC).  Values greater than zero for the seconds field denote      dates after the 0 hour January 1, 1970.  Values less than zero for      the seconds field denote dates before the 0 hour January 1, 1970.      In both cases, the nseconds field is to be added to the seconds      field for the final time representation.  For example, if the time      to be represented is one-half second before 0 hour January 1,      1970, the seconds field would have a value of negative one (-1)      and the nseconds fields would have a value of one-half second      (500000000).  Values greater than 999,999,999 for nseconds are      considered invalid.      This data type is used to pass time and date information.  A      server converts to and from its local representation of time when      processing time values, preserving as much accuracy as possible.      If the precision of timestamps stored for a file system object isShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 14]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      less than defined, loss of precision can occur.  An adjunct time      maintenance protocol is recommended to reduce client and server      time skew.   time_how4                  enum time_how4 {                          SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4 = 0,                          SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4 = 1                  };   settime4                  union settime4 switch (time_how4 set_it) {                   case SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4:                           nfstime4       time;                   default:                           void;                  };        The above definitions are used as the attribute definitions to        set time values.  If set_it is SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4, then the        server uses its local representation of time for the time value.   specdata4                  struct specdata4 {                          uint32_t specdata1;                          uint32_t specdata2;                  };        This data type represents additional information for the device        file types NF4CHR and NF4BLK.   fsid4                  struct fsid4 {                    uint64_t        major;                    uint64_t        minor;                  };        This type is the file system identifier that is used as a        mandatory attribute.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 15]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   fs_location4                  struct fs_location4 {                          utf8string    server<>;                          pathname4     rootpath;                  };   fs_locations4                  struct fs_locations4 {                          pathname4     fs_root;                          fs_location4  locations<>;                  };        The fs_location4 and fs_locations4 data types are used for the        fs_locations recommended attribute which is used for migration        and replication support.   fattr4                  struct fattr4 {                          bitmap4       attrmask;                          attrlist4     attr_vals;                  };        The fattr4 structure is used to represent file and directory        attributes.        The bitmap is a counted array of 32 bit integers used to contain        bit values.  The position of the integer in the array that        contains bit n can be computed from the expression (n / 32) and        its bit within that integer is (n mod 32).                                      0            1                    +-----------+-----------+-----------+--                    |  count    | 31  ..  0 | 63  .. 32 |                    +-----------+-----------+-----------+--   change_info4                  struct change_info4 {                          bool          atomic;                          changeid4     before;                          changeid4     after;                  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 16]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000        This structure is used with the CREATE, LINK, REMOVE, RENAME        operations to let the client the know value of the change        attribute for the directory in which the target file system        object resides.   clientaddr4                  struct clientaddr4 {                          /* see struct rpcb inRFC 1833 */                          string r_netid<>;    /* network id */                          string r_addr<>;     /* universal address */                  };        The clientaddr4 structure is used as part of the SETCLIENT        operation to either specify the address of the client that is        using a clientid or as part of the call back registration.   cb_client4                  struct cb_client4 {                          unsigned int  cb_program;                          clientaddr4   cb_location;                  };        This structure is used by the client to inform the server of its        call back address; includes the program number and client        address.   nfs_client_id4                  struct nfs_client_id4 {                          verifier4     verifier;                          opaque        id<>;                  };        This structure is part of the arguments to the SETCLIENTID        operation.   nfs_lockowner4                  struct nfs_lockowner4 {                          clientid4     clientid;                          opaque        owner<>;                  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 17]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000        This structure is used to identify the owner of a OPEN share or        file lock.3.  RPC and Security Flavor   The NFS version 4 protocol is a Remote Procedure Call (RPC)   application that uses RPC version 2 and the corresponding eXternal   Data Representation (XDR) as defined in [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  The   RPCSEC_GSS security flavor as defined in [RFC2203] MUST be used as   the mechanism to deliver stronger security for the NFS version 4   protocol.3.1.  Ports and Transports   Historically, NFS version 2 and version 3 servers have resided on   port 2049.  The registered port 2049 [RFC1700] for the NFS protocol   should be the default configuration.  Using the registered port for   NFS services means the NFS client will not need to use the RPC   binding protocols as described in [RFC1833]; this will allow NFS to   transit firewalls.   The transport used by the RPC service for the NFS version 4 protocol   MUST provide congestion control comparable to that defined for TCP in   [RFC2581].  If the operating environment implements TCP, the NFS   version 4 protocol SHOULD be supported over TCP.  The NFS client and   server may use other transports if they support congestion control as   defined above and in those cases a mechanism may be provided to   override TCP usage in favor of another transport.   If TCP is used as the transport, the client and server SHOULD use   persistent connections.  This will prevent the weakening of TCP's   congestion control via short lived connections and will improve   performance for the WAN environment by eliminating the need for SYN   handshakes.   Note that for various timers, the client and server should avoid   inadvertent synchronization of those timers.  For further discussion   of the general issue refer to [Floyd].3.2.  Security Flavors   Traditional RPC implementations have included AUTH_NONE, AUTH_SYS,   AUTH_DH, and AUTH_KRB4 as security flavors.  With [RFC2203] an   additional security flavor of RPCSEC_GSS has been introduced which   uses the functionality of GSS-API [RFC2078].  This allows for the use   of varying security mechanisms by the RPC layer without the   additional implementation overhead of adding RPC security flavors.   For NFS version 4, the RPCSEC_GSS security flavor MUST be used toShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 18]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   enable the mandatory security mechanism.  Other flavors, such as,   AUTH_NONE, AUTH_SYS, and AUTH_DH MAY be implemented as well.3.2.1.  Security mechanisms for NFS version 4   The use of RPCSEC_GSS requires selection of: mechanism, quality of   protection, and service (authentication, integrity, privacy).  The   remainder of this document will refer to these three parameters of   the RPCSEC_GSS security as the security triple.3.2.1.1.  Kerberos V5 as security triple   The Kerberos V5 GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC1964] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples.   column descriptions:   1 == number of pseudo flavor   2 == name of pseudo flavor   3 == mechanism's OID   4 == mechanism's algorithm(s)   5 == RPCSEC_GSS service1      2   3                    4              5-----------------------------------------------------------------------390003 krb51.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5    rpc_gss_svc_none390004 krb5i 1.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5  rpc_gss_svc_integrity390005 krb5p 1.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5  rpc_gss_svc_privacy                                  for integrity,                                  and 56 bit DES                                  for privacy.   Note that the pseudo flavor is presented here as a mapping aid to the   implementor.  Because this NFS protocol includes a method to   negotiate security and it understands the GSS-API mechanism, the   pseudo flavor is not needed.  The pseudo flavor is needed for NFS   version 3 since the security negotiation is done via the MOUNT   protocol.   For a discussion of NFS' use of RPCSEC_GSS and Kerberos V5, please   see [RFC2623].3.2.1.2.  LIPKEY as a security triple   The LIPKEY GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC2847] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples. The   definition of the columns matches the previous subsection "Kerberos   V5 as security triple"Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 19]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20001      2      3                    4              5-----------------------------------------------------------------------390006 lipkey 1.3.6.1.5.5.9        negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_none390007 lipkey-i 1.3.6.1.5.5.9      negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_integrity390008 lipkey-p 1.3.6.1.5.5.9      negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_privacy   The mechanism algorithm is listed as "negotiated".  This is because   LIPKEY is layered on SPKM-3 and in SPKM-3 [RFC2847] the   confidentiality and integrity algorithms are negotiated.  Since   SPKM-3 specifies HMAC-MD5 for integrity as MANDATORY, 128 bit   cast5CBC for confidentiality for privacy as MANDATORY, and further   specifies that HMAC-MD5 and cast5CBC MUST be listed first before   weaker algorithms, specifying "negotiated" in column 4 does not   impair interoperability.  In the event an SPKM-3 peer does not   support the mandatory algorithms, the other peer is free to accept or   reject the GSS-API context creation.   Because SPKM-3 negotiates the algorithms, subsequent calls to   LIPKEY's GSS_Wrap() and GSS_GetMIC() by RPCSEC_GSS will use a quality   of protection value of 0 (zero).  Seesection 5.2 of [RFC2025] for an   explanation.   LIPKEY uses SPKM-3 to create a secure channel in which to pass a user   name and password from the client to the user.  Once the user name   and password have been accepted by the server, calls to the LIPKEY   context are redirected to the SPKM-3 context.  See [RFC2847] for more   details.3.2.1.3.  SPKM-3 as a security triple   The SPKM-3 GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC2847] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples. The   definition of the columns matches the previous subsection "Kerberos   V5 as security triple".1      2      3                    4              5-----------------------------------------------------------------------390009 spkm3  1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3      negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_none390010 spkm3i 1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3      negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_integrity390011 spkm3p 1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3      negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_privacy   For a discussion as to why the mechanism algorithm is listed as   "negotiated", see the previous section "LIPKEY as a security triple."   Because SPKM-3 negotiates the algorithms, subsequent calls to SPKM-   3's GSS_Wrap() and GSS_GetMIC() by RPCSEC_GSS will use a quality of   protection value of 0 (zero).  Seesection 5.2 of [RFC2025] for an   explanation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 20]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   Even though LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, SPKM-3 is specified as a   mandatory set of triples to handle the situations where the initiator   (the client) is anonymous or where the initiator has its own   certificate.  If the initiator is anonymous, there will not be a user   name and password to send to the target (the server).  If the   initiator has its own certificate, then using passwords is   superfluous.3.3.  Security Negotiation   With the NFS version 4 server potentially offering multiple security   mechanisms, the client needs a method to determine or negotiate which   mechanism is to be used for its communication with the server.  The   NFS server may have multiple points within its file system name space   that are available for use by NFS clients.  In turn the NFS server   may be configured such that each of these entry points may have   different or multiple security mechanisms in use.   The security negotiation between client and server must be done with   a secure channel to eliminate the possibility of a third party   intercepting the negotiation sequence and forcing the client and   server to choose a lower level of security than required or desired.3.3.1.  Security Error   Based on the assumption that each NFS version 4 client and server   must support a minimum set of security (i.e. LIPKEY, SPKM-3, and   Kerberos-V5 all under RPCSEC_GSS), the NFS client will start its   communication with the server with one of the minimal security   triples.  During communication with the server, the client may   receive an NFS error of NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC.  This error allows the   server to notify the client that the security triple currently being   used is not appropriate for access to the server's file system   resources.  The client is then responsible for determining what   security triples are available at the server and choose one which is   appropriate for the client.3.3.2.  SECINFO   The new SECINFO operation will allow the client to determine, on a   per filehandle basis, what security triple is to be used for server   access.  In general, the client will not have to use the SECINFO   procedure except during initial communication with the server or when   the client crosses policy boundaries at the server.  It is possible   that the server's policies change during the client's interaction   therefore forcing the client to negotiate a new security triple.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 21]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20003.4.  Callback RPC Authentication   The callback RPC (described later) must mutually authenticate the NFS   server to the principal that acquired the clientid (also described   later), using the same security flavor the original SETCLIENTID   operation used. Because LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, it is   permissible for the server to use SPKM-3 and not LIPKEY for the   callback even if the client used LIPKEY for SETCLIENTID.   For AUTH_NONE, there are no principals, so this is a non-issue.   For AUTH_SYS, the server simply uses the AUTH_SYS credential that the   user used when it set up the delegation.   For AUTH_DH, one commonly used convention is that the server uses the   credential corresponding to this AUTH_DH principal:         unix.host@domain   where host and domain are variables corresponding to the name of   server host and directory services domain in which it lives such as a   Network Information System domain or a DNS domain.   Regardless of what security mechanism under RPCSEC_GSS is being used,   the NFS server, MUST identify itself in GSS-API via a   GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE name type.  GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE   names are of the form:         service@hostname   For NFS, the "service" element is         nfs   Implementations of security mechanisms will convert nfs@hostname to   various different forms. For Kerberos V5 and LIPKEY, the following   form is RECOMMENDED:         nfs/hostname   For Kerberos V5, nfs/hostname would be a server principal in the   Kerberos Key Distribution Center database.  For LIPKEY, this would be   the username passed to the target (the NFS version 4 client that   receives the callback).   It should be noted that LIPKEY may not work for callbacks, since the   LIPKEY client uses a user id/password.  If the NFS client receiving   the callback can authenticate the NFS server's user name/passwordShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 22]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   pair, and if the user that the NFS server is authenticating to has a   public key certificate, then it works.   In situations where NFS client uses LIPKEY and uses a per-host   principal for the SETCLIENTID operation, instead of using LIPKEY for   SETCLIENTID, it is RECOMMENDED that SPKM-3 with mutual authentication   be used.  This effectively means that the client will use a   certificate to authenticate and identify the initiator to the target   on the NFS server.  Using SPKM-3 and not LIPKEY has the following   advantages:   o  When the server does a callback, it must authenticate to the      principal used in the SETCLIENTID.  Even if LIPKEY is used,      because LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, the NFS client will need to      have a certificate that corresponds to the principal used in the      SETCLIENTID operation.  From an administrative perspective, having      a user name, password, and certificate for both the client and      server is redundant.   o  LIPKEY was intended to minimize additional infrastructure      requirements beyond a certificate for the target, and the      expectation is that existing password infrastructure can be      leveraged for the initiator.  In some environments, a per-host      password does not exist yet.  If certificates are used for any      per-host principals, then additional password infrastructure is      not needed.   o  In cases when a host is both an NFS client and server, it can      share the same per-host certificate.4.  Filehandles   The filehandle in the NFS protocol is a per server unique identifier   for a file system object.  The contents of the filehandle are opaque   to the client.  Therefore, the server is responsible for translating   the filehandle to an internal representation of the file system   object.  Since the filehandle is the client's reference to an object   and the client may cache this reference, the server SHOULD not reuse   a filehandle for another file system object.  If the server needs to   reuse a filehandle value, the time elapsed before reuse SHOULD be   large enough such that it is unlikely the client has a cached copy of   the reused filehandle value.  Note that a client may cache a   filehandle for a very long time.  For example, a client may cache NFS   data to local storage as a method to expand its effective cache size   and as a means to survive client restarts.  Therefore, the lifetime   of a cached filehandle may be extended.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 23]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20004.1.  Obtaining the First Filehandle   The operations of the NFS protocol are defined in terms of one or   more filehandles.  Therefore, the client needs a filehandle to   initiate communication with the server.  With the NFS version 2   protocol [RFC1094] and the NFS version 3 protocol [RFC1813], there   exists an ancillary protocol to obtain this first filehandle.  The   MOUNT protocol, RPC program number 100005, provides the mechanism of   translating a string based file system path name to a filehandle   which can then be used by the NFS protocols.   The MOUNT protocol has deficiencies in the area of security and use   via firewalls.  This is one reason that the use of the public   filehandle was introduced in [RFC2054] and [RFC2055].  With the use   of the public filehandle in combination with the LOOKUP procedure in   the NFS version 2 and 3 protocols, it has been demonstrated that the   MOUNT protocol is unnecessary for viable interaction between NFS   client and server.   Therefore, the NFS version 4 protocol will not use an ancillary   protocol for translation from string based path names to a   filehandle.  Two special filehandles will be used as starting points   for the NFS client.4.1.1.  Root Filehandle   The first of the special filehandles is the ROOT filehandle.  The   ROOT filehandle is the "conceptual" root of the file system name   space at the NFS server.  The client uses or starts with the ROOT   filehandle by employing the PUTROOTFH operation.  The PUTROOTFH   operation instructs the server to set the "current" filehandle to the   ROOT of the server's file tree.  Once this PUTROOTFH operation is   used, the client can then traverse the entirety of the server's file   tree with the LOOKUP procedure.  A complete discussion of the server   name space is in the section "NFS Server Name Space".4.1.2.  Public Filehandle   The second special filehandle is the PUBLIC filehandle.  Unlike the   ROOT filehandle, the PUBLIC filehandle may be bound or represent an   arbitrary file system object at the server.  The server is   responsible for this binding.  It may be that the PUBLIC filehandle   and the ROOT filehandle refer to the same file system object.   However, it is up to the administrative software at the server and   the policies of the server administrator to define the binding of the   PUBLIC filehandle and server file system object.  The client may not   make any assumptions about this binding.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 24]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20004.2.  Filehandle Types   In the NFS version 2 and 3 protocols, there was one type of   filehandle with a single set of semantics.  The NFS version 4   protocol introduces a new type of filehandle in an attempt to   accommodate certain server environments.  The first type of   filehandle is 'persistent'.  The semantics of a persistent filehandle   are the same as the filehandles of the NFS version 2 and 3 protocols.   The second or new type of filehandle is the "volatile" filehandle.   The volatile filehandle type is being introduced to address server   functionality or implementation issues which make correct   implementation of a persistent filehandle infeasible.  Some server   environments do not provide a file system level invariant that can be   used to construct a persistent filehandle.  The underlying server   file system may not provide the invariant or the server's file system   programming interfaces may not provide access to the needed   invariant.  Volatile filehandles may ease the implementation of   server functionality such as hierarchical storage management or file   system reorganization or migration.  However, the volatile filehandle   increases the implementation burden for the client.  However this   increased burden is deemed acceptable based on the overall gains   achieved by the protocol.   Since the client will need to handle persistent and volatile   filehandle differently, a file attribute is defined which may be used   by the client to determine the filehandle types being returned by the   server.4.2.1.  General Properties of a Filehandle   The filehandle contains all the information the server needs to   distinguish an individual file.  To the client, the filehandle is   opaque. The client stores filehandles for use in a later request and   can compare two filehandles from the same server for equality by   doing a byte-by-byte comparison.  However, the client MUST NOT   otherwise interpret the contents of filehandles.  If two filehandles   from the same server are equal, they MUST refer to the same file.  If   they are not equal, the client may use information provided by the   server, in the form of file attributes, to determine whether they   denote the same files or different files.  The client would do this   as necessary for client side caching.  Servers SHOULD try to maintain   a one-to-one correspondence between filehandles and files but this is   not required.  Clients MUST use filehandle comparisons only to   improve performance, not for correct behavior.  All clients need to   be prepared for situations in which it cannot be determined whether   two filehandles denote the same object and in such cases, avoid   making invalid assumptions which might cause incorrect behavior.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 25]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   Further discussion of filehandle and attribute comparison in the   context of data caching is presented in the section "Data Caching and   File Identity".   As an example, in the case that two different path names when   traversed at the server terminate at the same file system object, the   server SHOULD return the same filehandle for each path.  This can   occur if a hard link is used to create two file names which refer to   the same underlying file object and associated data.  For example, if   paths /a/b/c and /a/d/c refer to the same file, the server SHOULD   return the same filehandle for both path names traversals.4.2.2.  Persistent Filehandle   A persistent filehandle is defined as having a fixed value for the   lifetime of the file system object to which it refers.  Once the   server creates the filehandle for a file system object, the server   MUST accept the same filehandle for the object for the lifetime of   the object.  If the server restarts or reboots the NFS server must   honor the same filehandle value as it did in the server's previous   instantiation.  Similarly, if the file system is migrated, the new   NFS server must honor the same file handle as the old NFS server.   The persistent filehandle will be become stale or invalid when the   file system object is removed.  When the server is presented with a   persistent filehandle that refers to a deleted object, it MUST return   an error of NFS4ERR_STALE.  A filehandle may become stale when the   file system containing the object is no longer available.  The file   system may become unavailable if it exists on removable media and the   media is no longer available at the server or the file system in   whole has been destroyed or the file system has simply been removed   from the server's name space (i.e. unmounted in a Unix environment).4.2.3.  Volatile Filehandle   A volatile filehandle does not share the same longevity   characteristics of a persistent filehandle.  The server may determine   that a volatile filehandle is no longer valid at many different   points in time.  If the server can definitively determine that a   volatile filehandle refers to an object that has been removed, the   server should return NFS4ERR_STALE to the client (as is the case for   persistent filehandles).  In all other cases where the server   determines that a volatile filehandle can no longer be used, it   should return an error of NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 26]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The mandatory attribute "fh_expire_type" is used by the client to   determine what type of filehandle the server is providing for a   particular file system.  This attribute is a bitmask with the   following values:   FH4_PERSISTENT         The value of FH4_PERSISTENT is used to indicate a persistent         filehandle, which is valid until the object is removed from the         file system.  The server will not return NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED for         this filehandle.  FH4_PERSISTENT is defined as a value in which         none of the bits specified below are set.   FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN         The filehandle will not expire while client has the file open.         If this bit is set, then the values FH4_VOLATILE_ANY or         FH4_VOL_RENAME do not impact expiration while the file is open.         Once the file is closed or if the FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN bit is         false, the rest of the volatile related bits apply.   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY         The filehandle may expire at any time and will expire during         system migration and rename.   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION         The filehandle will expire during file system migration.  May         only be set if FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is not set.   FH4_VOL_RENAME         The filehandle may expire due to a rename.  This includes a         rename by the requesting client or a rename by another client.         May only be set if FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is not set.   Servers which provide volatile filehandles should deny a RENAME or   REMOVE that would affect an OPEN file or any of the components   leading to the OPEN file.  In addition, the server should deny all   RENAME or REMOVE requests during the grace or lease period upon   server restart.   The reader may be wondering why there are three FH4_VOL* bits and why   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is exclusive of FH4_VOL_MIGRATION and   FH4_VOL_RENAME.  If the a filehandle is normally persistent but   cannot persist across a file set migration, then the presence of the   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION or FH4_VOL_RENAME tells the client that it can   treat the file handle as persistent for purposes of maintaining a   file name to file handle cache, except for the specific event   described by the bit.  However, FH4_VOLATILE_ANY tells the client   that it should not maintain such a cache for unopened files.  A   server MUST not present FH4_VOLATILE_ANY with FH4_VOL_MIGRATION orShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 27]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   FH4_VOL_RENAME as this will lead to confusion.  FH4_VOLATILE_ANY   implies that the file handle will expire upon migration or rename, in   addition to other events.4.2.4.  One Method of Constructing a Volatile Filehandle   As mentioned, in some instances a filehandle is stale (no longer   valid; perhaps because the file was removed from the server) or it is   expired (the underlying file is valid but since the filehandle is   volatile, it may have expired).  Thus the server needs to be able to   return NFS4ERR_STALE in the former case and NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED in the   latter case. This can be done by careful construction of the volatile   filehandle.  One possible implementation follows.   A volatile filehandle, while opaque to the client could contain:   [volatile bit = 1 | server boot time | slot | generation number]   o  slot is an index in the server volatile filehandle table   o  generation number is the generation number for the table      entry/slot   If the server boot time is less than the current server boot time,   return NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.  If slot is out of range, return   NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE.  If the generation number does not match, return   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.   When the server reboots, the table is gone (it is volatile).   If volatile bit is 0, then it is a persistent filehandle with a   different structure following it.4.3.  Client Recovery from Filehandle Expiration   If possible, the client SHOULD recover from the receipt of an   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED error.  The client must take on additional   responsibility so that it may prepare itself to recover from the   expiration of a volatile filehandle.  If the server returns   persistent filehandles, the client does not need these additional   steps.   For volatile filehandles, most commonly the client will need to store   the component names leading up to and including the file system   object in question.  With these names, the client should be able to   recover by finding a filehandle in the name space that is still   available or by starting at the root of the server's file system name   space.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 28]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   If the expired filehandle refers to an object that has been removed   from the file system, obviously the client will not be able to   recover from the expired filehandle.   It is also possible that the expired filehandle refers to a file that   has been renamed.  If the file was renamed by another client, again   it is possible that the original client will not be able to recover.   However, in the case that the client itself is renaming the file and   the file is open, it is possible that the client may be able to   recover.  The client can determine the new path name based on the   processing of the rename request.  The client can then regenerate the   new filehandle based on the new path name.  The client could also use   the compound operation mechanism to construct a set of operations   like:            RENAME A B            LOOKUP B            GETFH5.  File Attributes   To meet the requirements of extensibility and increased   interoperability with non-Unix platforms, attributes must be handled   in a flexible manner.  The NFS Version 3 fattr3 structure contains a   fixed list of attributes that not all clients and servers are able to   support or care about.  The fattr3 structure can not be extended as   new needs arise and it provides no way to indicate non-support.  With   the NFS Version 4 protocol, the client will be able to ask what   attributes the server supports and will be able to request only those   attributes in which it is interested.   To this end, attributes will be divided into three groups: mandatory,   recommended, and named.  Both mandatory and recommended attributes   are supported in the NFS version 4 protocol by a specific and well-   defined encoding and are identified by number.  They are requested by   setting a bit in the bit vector sent in the GETATTR request; the   server response includes a bit vector to list what attributes were   returned in the response.  New mandatory or recommended attributes   may be added to the NFS protocol between major revisions by   publishing a standards-track RFC which allocates a new attribute   number value and defines the encoding for the attribute.  See the   section "Minor Versioning" for further discussion.   Named attributes are accessed by the new OPENATTR operation, which   accesses a hidden directory of attributes associated with a file   system object.  OPENATTR takes a filehandle for the object and   returns the filehandle for the attribute hierarchy.  The filehandle   for the named attributes is a directory object accessible by LOOKUPShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 29]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   or READDIR and contains files whose names represent the named   attributes and whose data bytes are the value of the attribute.  For   example:         LOOKUP     "foo"       ; look up file         GETATTR    attrbits         OPENATTR               ; access foo's named attributes         LOOKUP     "x11icon"   ; look up specific attribute         READ       0,4096      ; read stream of bytes   Named attributes are intended for data needed by applications rather   than by an NFS client implementation.  NFS implementors are strongly   encouraged to define their new attributes as recommended attributes   by bringing them to the IETF standards-track process.   The set of attributes which are classified as mandatory is   deliberately small since servers must do whatever it takes to support   them.  The recommended attributes may be unsupported; though a server   should support as many as it can.  Attributes are deemed mandatory if   the data is both needed by a large number of clients and is not   otherwise reasonably computable by the client when support is not   provided on the server.5.1.  Mandatory Attributes   These MUST be supported by every NFS Version 4 client and server in   order to ensure a minimum level of interoperability.  The server must   store and return these attributes and the client must be able to   function with an attribute set limited to these attributes.  With   just the mandatory attributes some client functionality may be   impaired or limited in some ways.  A client may ask for any of these   attributes to be returned by setting a bit in the GETATTR request and   the server must return their value.5.2.  Recommended Attributes   These attributes are understood well enough to warrant support in the   NFS Version 4 protocol.  However, they may not be supported on all   clients and servers.  A client may ask for any of these attributes to   be returned by setting a bit in the GETATTR request but must handle   the case where the server does not return them.  A client may ask for   the set of attributes the server supports and should not request   attributes the server does not support.  A server should be tolerant   of requests for unsupported attributes and simply not return them   rather than considering the request an error.  It is expected that   servers will support all attributes they comfortably can and only   fail to support attributes which are difficult to support in their   operating environments.  A server should provide attributes wheneverShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 30]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   they don't have to "tell lies" to the client.  For example, a file   modification time should be either an accurate time or should not be   supported by the server.  This will not always be comfortable to   clients but it seems that the client has a better ability to   fabricate or construct an attribute or do without the attribute.5.3.  Named Attributes   These attributes are not supported by direct encoding in the NFS   Version 4 protocol but are accessed by string names rather than   numbers and correspond to an uninterpreted stream of bytes which are   stored with the file system object.  The name space for these   attributes may be accessed by using the OPENATTR operation.  The   OPENATTR operation returns a filehandle for a virtual "attribute   directory" and further perusal of the name space may be done using   READDIR and LOOKUP operations on this filehandle.  Named attributes   may then be examined or changed by normal READ and WRITE and CREATE   operations on the filehandles returned from READDIR and LOOKUP.   Named attributes may have attributes.   It is recommended that servers support arbitrary named attributes.  A   client should not depend on the ability to store any named attributes   in the server's file system.  If a server does support named   attributes, a client which is also able to handle them should be able   to copy a file's data and meta-data with complete transparency from   one location to another; this would imply that names allowed for   regular directory entries are valid for named attribute names as   well.   Names of attributes will not be controlled by this document or other   IETF standards track documents.  See the section "IANA   Considerations" for further discussion.5.4.  Mandatory Attributes - Definitions   Name              #    DataType     Access   Description   ___________________________________________________________________   supp_attr         0    bitmap       READ     The bit vector which                                                would retrieve all                                                mandatory and                                                recommended attributes                                                that are supported for                                                this object.   type              1    nfs4_ftype   READ     The type of the object                                                (file, directory,                                                symlink)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 31]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   fh_expire_type    2    uint32       READ     Server uses this to                                                specify filehandle                                                expiration behavior to                                                the client.  See the                                                section "Filehandles"                                                for additional                                                description.   change            3    uint64       READ     A value created by the                                                server that the client                                                can use to determine                                                if file data,                                                directory contents or                                                attributes of the                                                object have been                                                modified.  The server                                                may return the                                                object's time_modify                                                attribute for this                                                attribute's value but                                                only if the file                                                system object can not                                                be updated more                                                frequently than the                                                resolution of                                                time_modify.   size              4    uint64       R/W      The size of the object                                                in bytes.   link_support      5    boolean      READ     Does the object's file                                                system supports hard                                                links?   symlink_support   6    boolean      READ     Does the object's file                                                system supports                                                symbolic links?   named_attr        7    boolean      READ     Does this object have                                                named attributes?   fsid              8    fsid4        READ     Unique file system                                                identifier for the                                                file system holding                                                this object.  fsid                                                contains major and                                                minor components each                                                of which are uint64.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 32]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   unique_handles    9    boolean      READ     Are two distinct                                                filehandles guaranteed                                                to refer to two                                                different file system                                                objects?   lease_time        10   nfs_lease4   READ     Duration of leases at                                                server in seconds.   rdattr_error      11   enum         READ     Error returned from                                                getattr during                                                readdir.5.5.  Recommended Attributes - Definitions   Name               #    Data Type      Access   Description   _____________________________________________________________________   ACL                12   nfsace4<>      R/W      The access control                                                   list for the object.   aclsupport         13   uint32         READ     Indicates what types                                                   of ACLs are supported                                                   on the current file                                                   system.   archive            14   boolean        R/W      Whether or not this                                                   file has been                                                   archived since the                                                   time of last                                                   modification                                                   (deprecated in favor                                                   of time_backup).   cansettime         15   boolean        READ     Is the server able to                                                   change the times for                                                   a file system object                                                   as specified in a                                                   SETATTR operation?   case_insensitive   16   boolean        READ     Are filename                                                   comparisons on this                                                   file system case                                                   insensitive?   case_preserving    17   boolean        READ     Is filename case on                                                   this file system                                                   preserved?Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 33]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   chown_restricted   18   boolean        READ     If TRUE, the server                                                   will reject any                                                   request to change                                                   either the owner or                                                   the group associated                                                   with a file if the                                                   caller is not a                                                   privileged user (for                                                   example, "root" in                                                   Unix operating                                                   environments or in NT                                                   the "Take Ownership"                                                   privilege)   filehandle         19   nfs4_fh        READ     The filehandle of                                                   this object                                                   (primarily for                                                   readdir requests).   fileid             20   uint64         READ     A number uniquely                                                   identifying the file                                                   within the file                                                   system.   files_avail        21   uint64         READ     File slots available                                                   to this user on the                                                   file system                                                   containing this                                                   object - this should                                                   be the smallest                                                   relevant limit.   files_free         22   uint64         READ     Free file slots on                                                   the file system                                                   containing this                                                   object - this should                                                   be the smallest                                                   relevant limit.   files_total        23   uint64         READ     Total file slots on                                                   the file system                                                   containing this                                                   object.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 34]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   fs_locations       24   fs_locations   READ     Locations where this                                                   file system may be                                                   found.  If the server                                                   returns NFS4ERR_MOVED                                                   as an error, this                                                   attribute must be                                                   supported.   hidden             25   boolean        R/W      Is file considered                                                   hidden with respect                                                   to the WIN32 API?   homogeneous        26   boolean        READ     Whether or not this                                                   object's file system                                                   is homogeneous, i.e.                                                   are per file system                                                   attributes the same                                                   for all file system's                                                   objects.   maxfilesize        27   uint64         READ     Maximum supported                                                   file size for the                                                   file system of this                                                   object.   maxlink            28   uint32         READ     Maximum number of                                                   links for this                                                   object.   maxname            29   uint32         READ     Maximum filename size                                                   supported for this                                                   object.   maxread            30   uint64         READ     Maximum read size                                                   supported for this                                                   object.   maxwrite           31   uint64         READ     Maximum write size                                                   supported for this                                                   object.  This                                                   attribute SHOULD be                                                   supported if the file                                                   is writable.  Lack of                                                   this attribute can                                                   lead to the client                                                   either wastingShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 35]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000                                                   bandwidth or not                                                   receiving the best                                                   performance.   mimetype           32   utf8<>         R/W      MIME body                                                   type/subtype of this                                                   object.   mode               33   mode4          R/W      Unix-style permission                                                   bits for this object                                                   (deprecated in favor                                                   of ACLs)   no_trunc           34   boolean        READ     If a name longer than                                                   name_max is used,                                                   will an error be                                                   returned or will the                                                   name be truncated?   numlinks           35   uint32         READ     Number of hard links                                                   to this object.   owner              36   utf8<>         R/W      The string name of                                                   the owner of this                                                   object.   owner_group        37   utf8<>         R/W      The string name of                                                   the group ownership                                                   of this object.   quota_avail_hard   38   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                   "Quota Attributes"                                                   section below.   quota_avail_soft   39   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                   "Quota Attributes"                                                   section below.   quota_used         40   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                   "Quota Attributes"                                                   section below.   rawdev             41   specdata4      READ     Raw device                                                   identifier.  Unix                                                   device major/minor                                                   node information.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 36]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   space_avail        42   uint64         READ     Disk space in bytes                                                   available to this                                                   user on the file                                                   system containing                                                   this object - this                                                   should be the                                                   smallest relevant                                                   limit.   space_free         43   uint64         READ     Free disk space in                                                   bytes on the file                                                   system containing                                                   this object - this                                                   should be the                                                   smallest relevant                                                   limit.   space_total        44   uint64         READ     Total disk space in                                                   bytes on the file                                                   system containing                                                   this object.   space_used         45   uint64         READ     Number of file system                                                   bytes allocated to                                                   this object.   system             46   boolean        R/W      Is this file a system                                                   file with respect to                                                   the WIN32 API?   time_access        47   nfstime4       READ     The time of last                                                   access to the object.   time_access_set    48   settime4       WRITE    Set the time of last                                                   access to the object.                                                   SETATTR use only.   time_backup        49   nfstime4       R/W      The time of last                                                   backup of the object.   time_create        50   nfstime4       R/W      The time of creation                                                   of the object. This                                                   attribute does not                                                   have any relation to                                                   the traditional Unix                                                   file attribute                                                   "ctime" or "change                                                   time".Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 37]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   time_delta         51   nfstime4       READ     Smallest useful                                                   server time                                                   granularity.   time_metadata      52   nfstime4       R/W      The time of last                                                   meta-data                                                   modification of the                                                   object.   time_modify        53   nfstime4       READ     The time of last                                                   modification to the                                                   object.   time_modify_set    54   settime4       WRITE    Set the time of last                                                   modification to the                                                   object.  SETATTR use                                                   only.5.6.  Interpreting owner and owner_group   The recommended attributes "owner" and "owner_group" are represented   in terms of a UTF-8 string.  To avoid a representation that is tied   to a particular underlying implementation at the client or server,   the use of the UTF-8 string has been chosen.  Note thatsection 6.1   of [RFC2624] provides additional rationale.  It is expected that the   client and server will have their own local representation of owner   and owner_group that is used for local storage or presentation to the   end user.  Therefore, it is expected that when these attributes are   transferred between the client and server that the local   representation is translated to a syntax of the form   "user@dns_domain".  This will allow for a client and server that do   not use the same local representation the ability to translate to a   common syntax that can be interpreted by both.   The translation is not specified as part of the protocol.  This   allows various solutions to be employed.  For example, a local   translation table may be consulted that maps between a numeric id to   the user@dns_domain syntax.  A name service may also be used to   accomplish the translation.  The "dns_domain" portion of the owner   string is meant to be a DNS domain name.  For example, user@ietf.org.   In the case where there is no translation available to the client or   server, the attribute value must be constructed without the "@".   Therefore, the absence of the @ from the owner or owner_group   attribute signifies that no translation was available and the   receiver of the attribute should not place any special meaning withShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 38]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   the attribute value.  Even though the attribute value can not be   translated, it may still be useful.  In the case of a client, the   attribute string may be used for local display of ownership.5.7.  Character Case Attributes   With respect to the case_insensitive and case_preserving attributes,   each UCS-4 character (which UTF-8 encodes) has a "long descriptive   name" [RFC1345] which may or may not included the word "CAPITAL" or   "SMALL".  The presence of SMALL or CAPITAL allows an NFS server to   implement unambiguous and efficient table driven mappings for case   insensitive comparisons, and non-case-preserving storage.  For   general character handling and internationalization issues, see the   section "Internationalization".5.8.  Quota Attributes   For the attributes related to file system quotas, the following   definitions apply:   quota_avail_soft         The value in bytes which represents the amount of additional         disk space that can be allocated to this file or directory         before the user may reasonably be warned.  It is understood         that this space may be consumed by allocations to other files         or directories though there is a rule as to which other files         or directories.   quota_avail_hard         The value in bytes which represent the amount of additional         disk space beyond the current allocation that can be allocated         to this file or directory before further allocations will be         refused.  It is understood that this space may be consumed by         allocations to other files or directories.   quota_used         The value in bytes which represent the amount of disc space         used by this file or directory and possibly a number of other         similar files or directories, where the set of "similar" meets         at least the criterion that allocating space to any file or         directory in the set will reduce the "quota_avail_hard" of         every other file or directory in the set.         Note that there may be a number of distinct but overlapping         sets of files or directories for which a quota_used value is         maintained. E.g. "all files with a given owner", "all files         with a given group owner". etc.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 39]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         The server is at liberty to choose any of those sets but should         do so in a repeatable way.  The rule may be configured per-         filesystem or may be "choose the set with the smallest quota".5.9.  Access Control Lists   The NFS ACL attribute is an array of access control entries (ACE).   There are various access control entry types.  The server is able to   communicate which ACE types are supported by returning the   appropriate value within the aclsupport attribute.  The types of ACEs   are defined as follows:   Type         Description   _____________________________________________________   ALLOW        Explicitly grants the access defined in                acemask4 to the file or directory.   DENY         Explicitly denies the access defined in                acemask4 to the file or directory.   AUDIT        LOG (system dependent) any access                attempt to a file or directory which                uses any of the access methods specified                in acemask4.   ALARM        Generate a system ALARM (system                dependent) when any access attempt is                made to a file or directory for the                access methods specified in acemask4.   The NFS ACE attribute is defined as follows:   typedef uint32_t        acetype4;   typedef uint32_t        aceflag4;   typedef uint32_t        acemask4;   struct nfsace4 {           acetype4        type;           aceflag4        flag;           acemask4        access_mask;           utf8string      who;   };   To determine if an ACCESS or OPEN request succeeds each nfsace4 entry   is processed in order by the server.  Only ACEs which have a "who"   that matches the requester are considered.  Each ACE is processed   until all of the bits of the requester's access have been ALLOWED.   Once a bit (see below) has been ALLOWED by an ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE, itShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 40]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   is no longer considered in the processing of later ACEs. If an   ACCESS_DENIED_ACE is encountered where the requester's mode still has   unALLOWED bits in common with the "access_mask" of the ACE, the   request is denied.   The bitmask constants used to represent the above definitions within   the aclsupport attribute are as follows:   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALLOW_ACL    = 0x00000001;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_DENY_ACL     = 0x00000002;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_AUDIT_ACL    = 0x00000004;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALARM_ACL    = 0x00000008;5.9.1.  ACE type   The semantics of the "type" field follow the descriptions provided   above.   The bitmask constants used for the type field are as follows:   const ACE4_ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE_TYPE      = 0x00000000;   const ACE4_ACCESS_DENIED_ACE_TYPE       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000003;5.9.2.  ACE flag   The "flag" field contains values based on the following descriptions.   ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE   Can be placed on a directory and indicates that this ACE should be   added to each new non-directory file created.   ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE   Can be placed on a directory and indicates that this ACE should be   added to each new directory created.   ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE   Can be placed on a directory but does not apply to the directory,   only to newly created files/directories as specified by the above two   flags.   ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 41]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   Can be placed on a directory. Normally when a new directory is   created and an ACE exists on the parent directory which is marked   ACL4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE, two ACEs are placed on the new directory.   One for the directory itself and one which is an inheritable ACE for   newly created directories.  This flag tells the server to not place   an ACE on the newly created directory which is inheritable by   subdirectories of the created directory.   ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   ACL4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   Both indicate for AUDIT and ALARM which state to log the event.  On   every ACCESS or OPEN call which occurs on a file or directory which   has an ACL that is of type ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE or   ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE, the attempted access is compared to the   ace4mask of these ACLs. If the access is a subset of ace4mask and the   identifier match, an AUDIT trail or an ALARM is generated.  By   default this happens regardless of the success or failure of the   ACCESS or OPEN call.   The flag ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG only produces the AUDIT or   ALARM if the ACCESS or OPEN call is successful. The   ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG causes the ALARM or AUDIT if the ACCESS   or OPEN call fails.   ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP   Indicates that the "who" refers to a GROUP as defined under Unix.   The bitmask constants used for the flag field are as follows:   const ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE             = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACE     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE             = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG       = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP             = 0x00000040;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 42]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20005.9.3.  ACE Access Mask   The access_mask field contains values based on the following:   Access                 Description   _______________________________________________________________   READ_DATA              Permission to read the data of the file   LIST_DIRECTORY         Permission to list the contents of a                          directory   WRITE_DATA             Permission to modify the file's data   ADD_FILE               Permission to add a new file to a                          directory   APPEND_DATA            Permission to append data to a file   ADD_SUBDIRECTORY       Permission to create a subdirectory to a                          directory   READ_NAMED_ATTRS       Permission to read the named attributes                          of a file   WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS      Permission to write the named attributes                          of a file   EXECUTE                Permission to execute a file   DELETE_CHILD           Permission to delete a file or directory                          within a directory   READ_ATTRIBUTES        The ability to read basic attributes                          (non-acls) of a file   WRITE_ATTRIBUTES       Permission to change basic attributes                          (non-acls) of a file   DELETE                 Permission to Delete the file   READ_ACL               Permission to Read the ACL   WRITE_ACL              Permission to Write the ACL   WRITE_OWNER            Permission to change the owner   SYNCHRONIZE            Permission to access file locally at the                          server with synchronous reads and writes   The bitmask constants used for the access mask field are as follows:   const ACE4_READ_DATA            = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_LIST_DIRECTORY       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_WRITE_DATA           = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_ADD_FILE             = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_APPEND_DATA          = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_ADD_SUBDIRECTORY     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_READ_NAMED_ATTRS     = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS    = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_EXECUTE              = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_DELETE_CHILD         = 0x00000040;   const ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES      = 0x00000080;   const ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES     = 0x00000100;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 43]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   const ACE4_DELETE               = 0x00010000;   const ACE4_READ_ACL             = 0x00020000;   const ACE4_WRITE_ACL            = 0x00040000;   const ACE4_WRITE_OWNER          = 0x00080000;   const ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE          = 0x00100000;5.9.4.  ACE who   There are several special identifiers ("who") which need to be   understood universally. Some of these identifiers cannot be   understood when an NFS client accesses the server, but have meaning   when a local process accesses the file. The ability to display and   modify these permissions is permitted over NFS.   Who                    Description   _______________________________________________________________   "OWNER"                The owner of the file.   "GROUP"                The group associated with the file.   "EVERYONE"             The world.   "INTERACTIVE"          Accessed from an interactive terminal.   "NETWORK"              Accessed via the network.   "DIALUP"               Accessed as a dialup user to the server.   "BATCH"                Accessed from a batch job.   "ANONYMOUS"            Accessed without any authentication.   "AUTHENTICATED"        Any authenticated user (opposite of                          ANONYMOUS)   "SERVICE"              Access from a system service.   To avoid conflict, these special identifiers are distinguish by an   appended "@" and should appear in the form "xxxx@" (note: no domain   name after the "@").  For example: ANONYMOUS@.6.  File System Migration and Replication   With the use of the recommended attribute "fs_locations", the NFS   version 4 server has a method of providing file system migration or   replication services.  For the purposes of migration and replication,   a file system will be defined as all files that share a given fsid   (both major and minor values are the same).   The fs_locations attribute provides a list of file system locations.   These locations are specified by providing the server name (either   DNS domain or IP address) and the path name representing the root of   the file system.  Depending on the type of service being provided,   the list will provide a new location or a set of alternate locations   for the file system.  The client will use this information to   redirect its requests to the new server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 44]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20006.1.  Replication   It is expected that file system replication will be used in the case   of read-only data.  Typically, the file system will be replicated on   two or more servers.  The fs_locations attribute will provide the   list of these locations to the client.  On first access of the file   system, the client should obtain the value of the fs_locations   attribute.  If, in the future, the client finds the server   unresponsive, the client may attempt to use another server specified   by fs_locations.   If applicable, the client must take the appropriate steps to recover   valid filehandles from the new server.  This is described in more   detail in the following sections.6.2.  Migration   File system migration is used to move a file system from one server   to another.  Migration is typically used for a file system that is   writable and has a single copy.  The expected use of migration is for   load balancing or general resource reallocation.  The protocol does   not specify how the file system will be moved between servers.  This   server-to-server transfer mechanism is left to the server   implementor.  However, the method used to communicate the migration   event between client and server is specified here.   Once the servers participating in the migration have completed the   move of the file system, the error NFS4ERR_MOVED will be returned for   subsequent requests received by the original server.  The   NFS4ERR_MOVED error is returned for all operations except GETATTR.   Upon receiving the NFS4ERR_MOVED error, the client will obtain the   value of the fs_locations attribute.  The client will then use the   contents of the attribute to redirect its requests to the specified   server.  To facilitate the use of GETATTR, operations such as PUTFH   must also be accepted by the server for the migrated file system's   filehandles.  Note that if the server returns NFS4ERR_MOVED, the   server MUST support the fs_locations attribute.   If the client requests more attributes than just fs_locations, the   server may return fs_locations only.  This is to be expected since   the server has migrated the file system and may not have a method of   obtaining additional attribute data.   The server implementor needs to be careful in developing a migration   solution.  The server must consider all of the state information   clients may have outstanding at the server.  This includes but is not   limited to locking/share state, delegation state, and asynchronousShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 45]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   file writes which are represented by WRITE and COMMIT verifiers.  The   server should strive to minimize the impact on its clients during and   after the migration process.6.3.  Interpretation of the fs_locations Attribute   The fs_location attribute is structured in the following way:   struct fs_location {           utf8string      server<>;           pathname4       rootpath;   };   struct fs_locations {           pathname4       fs_root;           fs_location     locations<>;   };   The fs_location struct is used to represent the location of a file   system by providing a server name and the path to the root of the   file system.  For a multi-homed server or a set of servers that use   the same rootpath, an array of server names may be provided.  An   entry in the server array is an UTF8 string and represents one of a   traditional DNS host name, IPv4 address, or IPv6 address.  It is not   a requirement that all servers that share the same rootpath be listed   in one fs_location struct.  The array of server names is provided for   convenience.  Servers that share the same rootpath may also be listed   in separate fs_location entries in the fs_locations attribute.   The fs_locations struct and attribute then contains an array of   locations.  Since the name space of each server may be constructed   differently, the "fs_root" field is provided.  The path represented   by fs_root represents the location of the file system in the server's   name space.  Therefore, the fs_root path is only associated with the   server from which the fs_locations attribute was obtained.  The   fs_root path is meant to aid the client in locating the file system   at the various servers listed.   As an example, there is a replicated file system located at two   servers (servA and servB).  At servA the file system is located at   path "/a/b/c".  At servB the file system is located at path "/x/y/z".   In this example the client accesses the file system first at servA   with a multi-component lookup path of "/a/b/c/d".  Since the client   used a multi-component lookup to obtain the filehandle at "/a/b/c/d",   it is unaware that the file system's root is located in servA's name   space at "/a/b/c".  When the client switches to servB, it will need   to determine that the directory it first referenced at servA is now   represented by the path "/x/y/z/d" on servB.  To facilitate this, theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 46]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   fs_locations attribute provided by servA would have a fs_root value   of "/a/b/c" and two entries in fs_location.  One entry in fs_location   will be for itself (servA) and the other will be for servB with a   path of "/x/y/z".  With this information, the client is able to   substitute "/x/y/z" for the "/a/b/c" at the beginning of its access   path and construct "/x/y/z/d" to use for the new server.6.4.  Filehandle Recovery for Migration or Replication   Filehandles for file systems that are replicated or migrated   generally have the same semantics as for file systems that are not   replicated or migrated.  For example, if a file system has persistent   filehandles and it is migrated to another server, the filehandle   values for the file system will be valid at the new server.   For volatile filehandles, the servers involved likely do not have a   mechanism to transfer filehandle format and content between   themselves.  Therefore, a server may have difficulty in determining   if a volatile filehandle from an old server should return an error of   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.  Therefore, the client is informed, with the use   of the fh_expire_type attribute, whether volatile filehandles will   expire at the migration or replication event.  If the bit   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION is set in the fh_expire_type attribute, the client   must treat the volatile filehandle as if the server had returned the   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED error.  At the migration or replication event in   the presence of the FH4_VOL_MIGRATION bit, the client will not   present the original or old volatile file handle to the new server.   The client will start its communication with the new server by   recovering its filehandles using the saved file names.7.  NFS Server Name Space7.1.  Server Exports   On a UNIX server the name space describes all the files reachable by   pathnames under the root directory or "/".  On a Windows NT server   the name space constitutes all the files on disks named by mapped   disk letters.  NFS server administrators rarely make the entire   server's file system name space available to NFS clients.  More often   portions of the name space are made available via an "export"   feature.  In previous versions of the NFS protocol, the root   filehandle for each export is obtained through the MOUNT protocol;   the client sends a string that identifies the export of name space   and the server returns the root filehandle for it.  The MOUNT   protocol supports an EXPORTS procedure that will enumerate the   server's exports.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 47]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20007.2.  Browsing Exports   The NFS version 4 protocol provides a root filehandle that clients   can use to obtain filehandles for these exports via a multi-component   LOOKUP.  A common user experience is to use a graphical user   interface (perhaps a file "Open" dialog window) to find a file via   progressive browsing through a directory tree.  The client must be   able to move from one export to another export via single-component,   progressive LOOKUP operations.   This style of browsing is not well supported by the NFS version 2 and   3 protocols.  The client expects all LOOKUP operations to remain   within a single server file system.  For example, the device   attribute will not change.  This prevents a client from taking name   space paths that span exports.   An automounter on the client can obtain a snapshot of the server's   name space using the EXPORTS procedure of the MOUNT protocol.  If it   understands the server's pathname syntax, it can create an image of   the server's name space on the client.  The parts of the name space   that are not exported by the server are filled in with a "pseudo file   system" that allows the user to browse from one mounted file system   to another.  There is a drawback to this representation of the   server's name space on the client: it is static.  If the server   administrator adds a new export the client will be unaware of it.7.3.  Server Pseudo File System   NFS version 4 servers avoid this name space inconsistency by   presenting all the exports within the framework of a single server   name space.  An NFS version 4 client uses LOOKUP and READDIR   operations to browse seamlessly from one export to another.  Portions   of the server name space that are not exported are bridged via a   "pseudo file system" that provides a view of exported directories   only.  A pseudo file system has a unique fsid and behaves like a   normal, read only file system.   Based on the construction of the server's name space, it is possible   that multiple pseudo file systems may exist.  For example,   /a         pseudo file system   /a/b       real file system   /a/b/c     pseudo file system   /a/b/c/d   real file system   Each of the pseudo file systems are consider separate entities and   therefore will have a unique fsid.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 48]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20007.4.  Multiple Roots   The DOS and Windows operating environments are sometimes described as   having "multiple roots".  File systems are commonly represented as   disk letters.  MacOS represents file systems as top level names.  NFS   version 4 servers for these platforms can construct a pseudo file   system above these root names so that disk letters or volume names   are simply directory names in the pseudo root.7.5.  Filehandle Volatility   The nature of the server's pseudo file system is that it is a logical   representation of file system(s) available from the server.   Therefore, the pseudo file system is most likely constructed   dynamically when the server is first instantiated.  It is expected   that the pseudo file system may not have an on disk counterpart from   which persistent filehandles could be constructed.  Even though it is   preferable that the server provide persistent filehandles for the   pseudo file system, the NFS client should expect that pseudo file   system filehandles are volatile.  This can be confirmed by checking   the associated "fh_expire_type" attribute for those filehandles in   question.  If the filehandles are volatile, the NFS client must be   prepared to recover a filehandle value (e.g. with a multi-component   LOOKUP) when receiving an error of NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.7.6.  Exported Root   If the server's root file system is exported, one might conclude that   a pseudo-file system is not needed.  This would be wrong.  Assume the   following file systems on a server:            /       disk1  (exported)            /a      disk2  (not exported)            /a/b    disk3  (exported)   Because disk2 is not exported, disk3 cannot be reached with simple   LOOKUPs.  The server must bridge the gap with a pseudo-file system.7.7.  Mount Point Crossing   The server file system environment may be constructed in such a way   that one file system contains a directory which is 'covered' or   mounted upon by a second file system.  For example:            /a/b            (file system 1)            /a/b/c/d        (file system 2)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 49]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The pseudo file system for this server may be constructed to look   like:            /               (place holder/not exported)            /a/b            (file system 1)            /a/b/c/d        (file system 2)   It is the server's responsibility to present the pseudo file system   that is complete to the client.  If the client sends a lookup request   for the path "/a/b/c/d", the server's response is the filehandle of   the file system "/a/b/c/d".  In previous versions of the NFS   protocol, the server would respond with the directory "/a/b/c/d"   within the file system "/a/b".   The NFS client will be able to determine if it crosses a server mount   point by a change in the value of the "fsid" attribute.7.8.  Security Policy and Name Space Presentation   The application of the server's security policy needs to be carefully   considered by the implementor.  One may choose to limit the   viewability of portions of the pseudo file system based on the   server's perception of the client's ability to authenticate itself   properly.  However, with the support of multiple security mechanisms   and the ability to negotiate the appropriate use of these mechanisms,   the server is unable to properly determine if a client will be able   to authenticate itself.  If, based on its policies, the server   chooses to limit the contents of the pseudo file system, the server   may effectively hide file systems from a client that may otherwise   have legitimate access.8.  File Locking and Share Reservations   Integrating locking into the NFS protocol necessarily causes it to be   state-full.  With the inclusion of "share" file locks the protocol   becomes substantially more dependent on state than the traditional   combination of NFS and NLM [XNFS].  There are three components to   making this state manageable:   o  Clear division between client and server   o  Ability to reliably detect inconsistency in state between client      and server   o  Simple and robust recovery mechanismsShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 50]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   In this model, the server owns the state information.  The client   communicates its view of this state to the server as needed.  The   client is also able to detect inconsistent state before modifying a   file.   To support Win32 "share" locks it is necessary to atomically OPEN or   CREATE files.  Having a separate share/unshare operation would not   allow correct implementation of the Win32 OpenFile API.  In order to   correctly implement share semantics, the previous NFS protocol   mechanisms used when a file is opened or created (LOOKUP, CREATE,   ACCESS) need to be replaced.  The NFS version 4 protocol has an OPEN   operation that subsumes the functionality of LOOKUP, CREATE, and   ACCESS.  However, because many operations require a filehandle, the   traditional LOOKUP is preserved to map a file name to filehandle   without establishing state on the server.  The policy of granting   access or modifying files is managed by the server based on the   client's state.  These mechanisms can implement policy ranging from   advisory only locking to full mandatory locking.8.1.  Locking   It is assumed that manipulating a lock is rare when compared to READ   and WRITE operations.  It is also assumed that crashes and network   partitions are relatively rare.  Therefore it is important that the   READ and WRITE operations have a lightweight mechanism to indicate if   they possess a held lock.  A lock request contains the heavyweight   information required to establish a lock and uniquely define the lock   owner.   The following sections describe the transition from the heavy weight   information to the eventual stateid used for most client and server   locking and lease interactions.8.1.1.  Client ID   For each LOCK request, the client must identify itself to the server.   This is done in such a way as to allow for correct lock   identification and crash recovery.  Client identification is   accomplished with two values.   o  A verifier that is used to detect client reboots.   o  A variable length opaque array to uniquely define a client.         For an operating system this may be a fully qualified host name         or IP address.  For a user level NFS client it may additionally         contain a process id or other unique sequence.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 51]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The data structure for the Client ID would then appear as:            struct nfs_client_id {                    opaque verifier[4];                    opaque id<>;            }   It is possible through the mis-configuration of a client or the   existence of a rogue client that two clients end up using the same   nfs_client_id.  This situation is avoided by "negotiating" the   nfs_client_id between client and server with the use of the   SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operations.  The following   describes the two scenarios of negotiation.   1  Client has never connected to the server      In this case the client generates an nfs_client_id and unless      another client has the same nfs_client_id.id field, the server      accepts the request. The server also records the principal (or      principal to uid mapping) from the credential in the RPC request      that contains the nfs_client_id negotiation request (SETCLIENTID      operation).      Two clients might still use the same nfs_client_id.id due to      perhaps configuration error.  For example, a High Availability      configuration where the nfs_client_id.id is derived from the      ethernet controller address and both systems have the same      address.  In this case, the result is a switched union that      returns, in addition to NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE, the network address      (the rpcbind netid and universal address) of the client that is      using the id.   2  Client is re-connecting to the server after a client reboot      In this case, the client still generates an nfs_client_id but the      nfs_client_id.id field will be the same as the nfs_client_id.id      generated prior to reboot.  If the server finds that the      principal/uid is equal to the previously "registered"      nfs_client_id.id, then locks associated with the old nfs_client_id      are immediately released.  If the principal/uid is not equal, then      this is a rogue client and the request is returned in error.  For      more discussion of crash recovery semantics, see the section on      "Crash Recovery".      It is possible for a retransmission of request to be received by      the server after the server has acted upon and responded to the      original client request.  Therefore to mitigate effects of the      retransmission of the SETCLIENTID operation, the client and serverShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 52]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      use a confirmation step.  The server returns a confirmation      verifier that the client then sends to the server in the      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation.  Once the server receives the      confirmation from the client, the locking state for the client is      released.   In both cases, upon success, NFS4_OK is returned.  To help reduce the   amount of data transferred on OPEN and LOCK, the server will also   return a unique 64-bit clientid value that is a shorthand reference   to the nfs_client_id values presented by the client.  From this point   forward, the client will use the clientid to refer to itself.   The clientid assigned by the server should be chosen so that it will   not conflict with a clientid previously assigned by the server.  This   applies across server restarts or reboots.  When a clientid is   presented to a server and that clientid is not recognized, as would   happen after a server reboot, the server will reject the request with   the error NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID.  When this happens, the client must   obtain a new clientid by use of the SETCLIENTID operation and then   proceed to any other necessary recovery for the server reboot case   (See the section "Server Failure and Recovery").   The client must also employ the SETCLIENTID operation when it   receives a NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID error using a stateid derived from   its current clientid, since this also indicates a server reboot which   has invalidated the existing clientid (see the next section   "nfs_lockowner and stateid Definition" for details).8.1.2.  Server Release of Clientid   If the server determines that the client holds no associated state   for its clientid, the server may choose to release the clientid.  The   server may make this choice for an inactive client so that resources   are not consumed by those intermittently active clients.  If the   client contacts the server after this release, the server must ensure   the client receives the appropriate error so that it will use the   SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence to establish a new identity.   It should be clear that the server must be very hesitant to release a   clientid since the resulting work on the client to recover from such   an event will be the same burden as if the server had failed and   restarted.  Typically a server would not release a clientid unless   there had been no activity from that client for many minutes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 53]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20008.1.3.  nfs_lockowner and stateid Definition   When requesting a lock, the client must present to the server the   clientid and an identifier for the owner of the requested lock.   These two fields are referred to as the nfs_lockowner and the   definition of those fields are:   o  A clientid returned by the server as part of the client's use of      the SETCLIENTID operation.   o  A variable length opaque array used to uniquely define the owner      of a lock managed by the client.         This may be a thread id, process id, or other unique value.   When the server grants the lock, it responds with a unique 64-bit   stateid.  The stateid is used as a shorthand reference to the   nfs_lockowner, since the server will be maintaining the   correspondence between them.   The server is free to form the stateid in any manner that it chooses   as long as it is able to recognize invalid and out-of-date stateids.   This requirement includes those stateids generated by earlier   instances of the server.  From this, the client can be properly   notified of a server restart.  This notification will occur when the   client presents a stateid to the server from a previous   instantiation.   The server must be able to distinguish the following situations and   return the error as specified:   o  The stateid was generated by an earlier server instance (i.e.      before a server reboot).  The error NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID should      be returned.   o  The stateid was generated by the current server instance but the      stateid no longer designates the current locking state for the      lockowner-file pair in question (i.e. one or more locking      operations has occurred).  The error NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID should be      returned.      This error condition will only occur when the client issues a      locking request which changes a stateid while an I/O request that      uses that stateid is outstanding.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 54]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  The stateid was generated by the current server instance but the      stateid does not designate a locking state for any active      lockowner-file pair.  The error NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID should be      returned.      This error condition will occur when there has been a logic error      on the part of the client or server.  This should not happen.   One mechanism that may be used to satisfy these requirements is for   the server to divide stateids into three fields:   o  A server verifier which uniquely designates a particular server      instantiation.   o  An index into a table of locking-state structures.   o  A sequence value which is incremented for each stateid that is      associated with the same index into the locking-state table.   By matching the incoming stateid and its field values with the state   held at the server, the server is able to easily determine if a   stateid is valid for its current instantiation and state.  If the   stateid is not valid, the appropriate error can be supplied to the   client.8.1.4.  Use of the stateid   All READ and WRITE operations contain a stateid.  If the   nfs_lockowner performs a READ or WRITE on a range of bytes within a   locked range, the stateid (previously returned by the server) must be   used to indicate that the appropriate lock (record or share) is held.   If no state is established by the client, either record lock or share   lock, a stateid of all bits 0 is used.  If no conflicting locks are   held on the file, the server may service the READ or WRITE operation.   If a conflict with an explicit lock occurs, an error is returned for   the operation (NFS4ERR_LOCKED). This allows "mandatory locking" to be   implemented.   A stateid of all bits 1 (one) allows READ operations to bypass record   locking checks at the server.  However, WRITE operations with stateid   with bits all 1 (one) do not bypass record locking checks.  File   locking checks are handled by the OPEN operation (see the section   "OPEN/CLOSE Operations").   An explicit lock may not be granted while a READ or WRITE operation   with conflicting implicit locking is being performed.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 55]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20008.1.5.  Sequencing of Lock Requests   Locking is different than most NFS operations as it requires "at-   most-one" semantics that are not provided by ONCRPC.  ONCRPC over a   reliable transport is not sufficient because a sequence of locking   requests may span multiple TCP connections.  In the face of   retransmission or reordering, lock or unlock requests must have a   well defined and consistent behavior.  To accomplish this, each lock   request contains a sequence number that is a consecutively increasing   integer.  Different nfs_lockowners have different sequences.  The   server maintains the last sequence number (L) received and the   response that was returned.   Note that for requests that contain a sequence number, for each   nfs_lockowner, there should be no more than one outstanding request.   If a request with a previous sequence number (r < L) is received, it   is rejected with the return of error NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID.  Given a   properly-functioning client, the response to (r) must have been   received before the last request (L) was sent.  If a duplicate of   last request (r == L) is received, the stored response is returned.   If a request beyond the next sequence (r == L + 2) is received, it is   rejected with the return of error NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID.  Sequence   history is reinitialized whenever the client verifier changes.   Since the sequence number is represented with an unsigned 32-bit   integer, the arithmetic involved with the sequence number is mod   2^32.   It is critical the server maintain the last response sent to the   client to provide a more reliable cache of duplicate non-idempotent   requests than that of the traditional cache described in [Juszczak].   The traditional duplicate request cache uses a least recently used   algorithm for removing unneeded requests. However, the last lock   request and response on a given nfs_lockowner must be cached as long   as the lock state exists on the server.8.1.6.  Recovery from Replayed Requests   As described above, the sequence number is per nfs_lockowner.  As   long as the server maintains the last sequence number received and   follows the methods described above, there are no risks of a   Byzantine router re-sending old requests.  The server need only   maintain the nfs_lockowner, sequence number state as long as there   are open files or closed files with locks outstanding.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 56]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN, OPEN_DOWNGRADE, and CLOSE each contain a sequence   number and therefore the risk of the replay of these operations   resulting in undesired effects is non-existent while the server   maintains the nfs_lockowner state.8.1.7.  Releasing nfs_lockowner State   When a particular nfs_lockowner no longer holds open or file locking   state at the server, the server may choose to release the sequence   number state associated with the nfs_lockowner.  The server may make   this choice based on lease expiration, for the reclamation of server   memory, or other implementation specific details.  In any event, the   server is able to do this safely only when the nfs_lockowner no   longer is being utilized by the client.  The server may choose to   hold the nfs_lockowner state in the event that retransmitted requests   are received.  However, the period to hold this state is   implementation specific.   In the case that a LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN_DOWNGRADE, or CLOSE is   retransmitted after the server has previously released the   nfs_lockowner state, the server will find that the nfs_lockowner has   no files open and an error will be returned to the client.  If the   nfs_lockowner does have a file open, the stateid will not match and   again an error is returned to the client.   In the case that an OPEN is retransmitted and the nfs_lockowner is   being used for the first time or the nfs_lockowner state has been   previously released by the server, the use of the OPEN_CONFIRM   operation will prevent incorrect behavior.  When the server observes   the use of the nfs_lockowner for the first time, it will direct the   client to perform the OPEN_CONFIRM for the corresponding OPEN.  This   sequence establishes the use of an nfs_lockowner and associated   sequence number.  See the section "OPEN_CONFIRM - Confirm Open" for   further details.8.2.  Lock Ranges   The protocol allows a lock owner to request a lock with one byte   range and then either upgrade or unlock a sub-range of the initial   lock.  It is expected that this will be an uncommon type of request.   In any case, servers or server file systems may not be able to   support sub-range lock semantics.  In the event that a server   receives a locking request that represents a sub-range of current   locking state for the lock owner, the server is allowed to return the   error NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE to signify that it does not support sub-   range lock operations.  Therefore, the client should be prepared to   receive this error and, if appropriate, report the error to the   requesting application.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 57]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The client is discouraged from combining multiple independent locking   ranges that happen to be adjacent into a single request since the   server may not support sub-range requests and for reasons related to   the recovery of file locking state in the event of server failure.   As discussed in the section "Server Failure and Recovery" below, the   server may employ certain optimizations during recovery that work   effectively only when the client's behavior during lock recovery is   similar to the client's locking behavior prior to server failure.8.3.  Blocking Locks   Some clients require the support of blocking locks.  The NFS version   4 protocol must not rely on a callback mechanism and therefore is   unable to notify a client when a previously denied lock has been   granted.  Clients have no choice but to continually poll for the   lock.  This presents a fairness problem.  Two new lock types are   added, READW and WRITEW, and are used to indicate to the server that   the client is requesting a blocking lock.  The server should maintain   an ordered list of pending blocking locks.  When the conflicting lock   is released, the server may wait the lease period for the first   waiting client to re-request the lock.  After the lease period   expires the next waiting client request is allowed the lock.  Clients   are required to poll at an interval sufficiently small that it is   likely to acquire the lock in a timely manner.  The server is not   required to maintain a list of pending blocked locks as it is used to   increase fairness and not correct operation.  Because of the   unordered nature of crash recovery, storing of lock state to stable   storage would be required to guarantee ordered granting of blocking   locks.   Servers may also note the lock types and delay returning denial of   the request to allow extra time for a conflicting lock to be   released, allowing a successful return.  In this way, clients can   avoid the burden of needlessly frequent polling for blocking locks.   The server should take care in the length of delay in the event the   client retransmits the request.8.4.  Lease Renewal   The purpose of a lease is to allow a server to remove stale locks   that are held by a client that has crashed or is otherwise   unreachable.  It is not a mechanism for cache consistency and lease   renewals may not be denied if the lease interval has not expired.   The following events cause implicit renewal of all of the leases for   a given client (i.e. all those sharing a given clientid).  Each of   these is a positive indication that the client is still active andShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 58]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   that the associated state held at the server, for the client, is   still valid.   o  An OPEN with a valid clientid.   o  Any operation made with a valid stateid (CLOSE, DELEGRETURN, LOCK,      LOCKU, OPEN, OPEN_CONFIRM, READ, RENEW, SETATTR, WRITE).  This      does not include the special stateids of all bits 0 or all bits 1.         Note that if the client had restarted or rebooted, the client         would not be making these requests without issuing the         SETCLIENTID operation.  The use of the SETCLIENTID operation         (possibly with the addition of the optional SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM         operation) notifies the server to drop the locking state         associated with the client.         If the server has rebooted, the stateids (NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID         error) or the clientid (NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID error) will not         be valid hence preventing spurious renewals.   This approach allows for low overhead lease renewal which scales   well.  In the typical case no extra RPC calls are required for lease   renewal and in the worst case one RPC is required every lease period   (i.e. a RENEW operation).  The number of locks held by the client is   not a factor since all state for the client is involved with the   lease renewal action.   Since all operations that create a new lease also renew existing   leases, the server must maintain a common lease expiration time for   all valid leases for a given client.  This lease time can then be   easily updated upon implicit lease renewal actions.8.5.  Crash Recovery   The important requirement in crash recovery is that both the client   and the server know when the other has failed.  Additionally, it is   required that a client sees a consistent view of data across server   restarts or reboots.  All READ and WRITE operations that may have   been queued within the client or network buffers must wait until the   client has successfully recovered the locks protecting the READ and   WRITE operations.8.5.1.  Client Failure and Recovery   In the event that a client fails, the server may recover the client's   locks when the associated leases have expired.  Conflicting locks   from another client may only be granted after this lease expiration.   If the client is able to restart or reinitialize within the leaseShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 59]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   period the client may be forced to wait the remainder of the lease   period before obtaining new locks.   To minimize client delay upon restart, lock requests are associated   with an instance of the client by a client supplied verifier.  This   verifier is part of the initial SETCLIENTID call made by the client.   The server returns a clientid as a result of the SETCLIENTID   operation.  The client then confirms the use of the verifier with   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM.  The clientid in combination with an opaque   owner field is then used by the client to identify the lock owner for   OPEN.  This chain of associations is then used to identify all locks   for a particular client.   Since the verifier will be changed by the client upon each   initialization, the server can compare a new verifier to the verifier   associated with currently held locks and determine that they do not   match.  This signifies the client's new instantiation and subsequent   loss of locking state.  As a result, the server is free to release   all locks held which are associated with the old clientid which was   derived from the old verifier.   For secure environments, a change in the verifier must only cause the   release of locks associated with the authenticated requester.  This   is required to prevent a rogue entity from freeing otherwise valid   locks.   Note that the verifier must have the same uniqueness properties of   the verifier for the COMMIT operation.8.5.2.  Server Failure and Recovery   If the server loses locking state (usually as a result of a restart   or reboot), it must allow clients time to discover this fact and re-   establish the lost locking state.  The client must be able to re-   establish the locking state without having the server deny valid   requests because the server has granted conflicting access to another   client.  Likewise, if there is the possibility that clients have not   yet re-established their locking state for a file, the server must   disallow READ and WRITE operations for that file.  The duration of   this recovery period is equal to the duration of the lease period.   A client can determine that server failure (and thus loss of locking   state) has occurred, when it receives one of two errors.  The   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID error indicates a stateid invalidated by a   reboot or restart.  The NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID error indicates a   clientid invalidated by reboot or restart.  When either of these are   received, the client must establish a new clientid (See the section   "Client ID") and re-establish the locking state as discussed below.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 60]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The period of special handling of locking and READs and WRITEs, equal   in duration to the lease period, is referred to as the "grace   period".  During the grace period, clients recover locks and the   associated state by reclaim-type locking requests (i.e. LOCK requests   with reclaim set to true and OPEN operations with a claim type of   CLAIM_PREVIOUS).  During the grace period, the server must reject   READ and WRITE operations and non-reclaim locking requests (i.e.   other LOCK and OPEN operations) with an error of NFS4ERR_GRACE.   If the server can reliably determine that granting a non-reclaim   request will not conflict with reclamation of locks by other clients,   the NFS4ERR_GRACE error does not have to be returned and the non-   reclaim client request can be serviced.  For the server to be able to   service READ and WRITE operations during the grace period, it must   again be able to guarantee that no possible conflict could arise   between an impending reclaim locking request and the READ or WRITE   operation.  If the server is unable to offer that guarantee, the   NFS4ERR_GRACE error must be returned to the client.   For a server to provide simple, valid handling during the grace   period, the easiest method is to simply reject all non-reclaim   locking requests and READ and WRITE operations by returning the   NFS4ERR_GRACE error.  However, a server may keep information about   granted locks in stable storage.  With this information, the server   could determine if a regular lock or READ or WRITE operation can be   safely processed.   For example, if a count of locks on a given file is available in   stable storage, the server can track reclaimed locks for the file and   when all reclaims have been processed, non-reclaim locking requests   may be processed.  This way the server can ensure that non-reclaim   locking requests will not conflict with potential reclaim requests.   With respect to I/O requests, if the server is able to determine that   there are no outstanding reclaim requests for a file by information   from stable storage or another similar mechanism, the processing of   I/O requests could proceed normally for the file.   To reiterate, for a server that allows non-reclaim lock and I/O   requests to be processed during the grace period, it MUST determine   that no lock subsequently reclaimed will be rejected and that no lock   subsequently reclaimed would have prevented any I/O operation   processed during the grace period.   Clients should be prepared for the return of NFS4ERR_GRACE errors for   non-reclaim lock and I/O requests.  In this case the client should   employ a retry mechanism for the request.  A delay (on the order of   several seconds) between retries should be used to avoid overwhelming   the server.  Further discussion of the general is included inShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 61]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   [Floyd].  The client must account for the server that is able to   perform I/O and non-reclaim locking requests within the grace period   as well as those that can not do so.   A reclaim-type locking request outside the server's grace period can   only succeed if the server can guarantee that no conflicting lock or   I/O request has been granted since reboot or restart.8.5.3.  Network Partitions and Recovery   If the duration of a network partition is greater than the lease   period provided by the server, the server will have not received a   lease renewal from the client.  If this occurs, the server may free   all locks held for the client.  As a result, all stateids held by the   client will become invalid or stale.  Once the client is able to   reach the server after such a network partition, all I/O submitted by   the client with the now invalid stateids will fail with the server   returning the error NFS4ERR_EXPIRED.  Once this error is received,   the client will suitably notify the application that held the lock.   As a courtesy to the client or as an optimization, the server may   continue to hold locks on behalf of a client for which recent   communication has extended beyond the lease period.  If the server   receives a lock or I/O request that conflicts with one of these   courtesy locks, the server must free the courtesy lock and grant the   new request.   If the server continues to hold locks beyond the expiration of a   client's lease, the server MUST employ a method of recording this   fact in its stable storage.  Conflicting locks requests from another   client may be serviced after the lease expiration.  There are various   scenarios involving server failure after such an event that require   the storage of these lease expirations or network partitions.  One   scenario is as follows:         A client holds a lock at the server and encounters a network         partition and is unable to renew the associated lease.  A         second client obtains a conflicting lock and then frees the         lock.  After the unlock request by the second client, the         server reboots or reinitializes.  Once the server recovers, the         network partition heals and the original client attempts to         reclaim the original lock.   In this scenario and without any state information, the server will   allow the reclaim and the client will be in an inconsistent state   because the server or the client has no knowledge of the conflicting   lock.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 62]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The server may choose to store this lease expiration or network   partitioning state in a way that will only identify the client as a   whole.  Note that this may potentially lead to lock reclaims being   denied unnecessarily because of a mix of conflicting and non-   conflicting locks.  The server may also choose to store information   about each lock that has an expired lease with an associated   conflicting lock.  The choice of the amount and type of state   information that is stored is left to the implementor.  In any case,   the server must have enough state information to enable correct   recovery from multiple partitions and multiple server failures.8.6.  Recovery from a Lock Request Timeout or Abort   In the event a lock request times out, a client may decide to not   retry the request.  The client may also abort the request when the   process for which it was issued is terminated (e.g. in UNIX due to a   signal.  It is possible though that the server received the request   and acted upon it.  This would change the state on the server without   the client being aware of the change.  It is paramount that the   client re-synchronize state with server before it attempts any other   operation that takes a seqid and/or a stateid with the same   nfs_lockowner. This is straightforward to do without a special re-   synchronize operation.   Since the server maintains the last lock request and response   received on the nfs_lockowner, for each nfs_lockowner, the client   should cache the last lock request it sent such that the lock request   did not receive a response.  From this, the next time the client does   a lock operation for the nfs_lockowner, it can send the cached   request, if there is one, and if the request was one that established   state (e.g. a LOCK or OPEN operation) the client can follow up with a   request to remove the state (e.g. a LOCKU or CLOSE operation).  With   this approach, the sequencing and stateid information on the client   and server for the given nfs_lockowner will re-synchronize and in   turn the lock state will re-synchronize.8.7.  Server Revocation of Locks   At any point, the server can revoke locks held by a client and the   client must be prepared for this event.  When the client detects that   its locks have been or may have been revoked, the client is   responsible for validating the state information between itself and   the server.  Validating locking state for the client means that it   must verify or reclaim state for each lock currently held.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 63]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The first instance of lock revocation is upon server reboot or re-   initialization.  In this instance the client will receive an error   (NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID or NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID) and the client will   proceed with normal crash recovery as described in the previous   section.   The second lock revocation event is the inability to renew the lease   period.  While this is considered a rare or unusual event, the client   must be prepared to recover.  Both the server and client will be able   to detect the failure to renew the lease and are capable of   recovering without data corruption.  For the server, it tracks the   last renewal event serviced for the client and knows when the lease   will expire.  Similarly, the client must track operations which will   renew the lease period.  Using the time that each such request was   sent and the time that the corresponding reply was received, the   client should bound the time that the corresponding renewal could   have occurred on the server and thus determine if it is possible that   a lease period expiration could have occurred.   The third lock revocation event can occur as a result of   administrative intervention within the lease period.  While this is   considered a rare event, it is possible that the server's   administrator has decided to release or revoke a particular lock held   by the client.  As a result of revocation, the client will receive an   error of NFS4ERR_EXPIRED and the error is received within the lease   period for the lock.  In this instance the client may assume that   only the nfs_lockowner's locks have been lost.  The client notifies   the lock holder appropriately.  The client may not assume the lease   period has been renewed as a result of failed operation.   When the client determines the lease period may have expired, the   client must mark all locks held for the associated lease as   "unvalidated".  This means the client has been unable to re-establish   or confirm the appropriate lock state with the server.  As described   in the previous section on crash recovery, there are scenarios in   which the server may grant conflicting locks after the lease period   has expired for a client.  When it is possible that the lease period   has expired, the client must validate each lock currently held to   ensure that a conflicting lock has not been granted. The client may   accomplish this task by issuing an I/O request, either a pending I/O   or a zero-length read, specifying the stateid associated with the   lock in question. If the response to the request is success, the   client has validated all of the locks governed by that stateid and   re-established the appropriate state between itself and the server.   If the I/O request is not successful, then one or more of the locks   associated with the stateid was revoked by the server and the client   must notify the owner.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 64]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20008.8.  Share Reservations   A share reservation is a mechanism to control access to a file.  It   is a separate and independent mechanism from record locking.  When a   client opens a file, it issues an OPEN operation to the server   specifying the type of access required (READ, WRITE, or BOTH) and the   type of access to deny others (deny NONE, READ, WRITE, or BOTH).  If   the OPEN fails the client will fail the application's open request.   Pseudo-code definition of the semantics:               if ((request.access & file_state.deny)) ||                     (request.deny & file_state.access))                             return (NFS4ERR_DENIED)   The constants used for the OPEN and OPEN_DOWNGRADE operations for the   access and deny fields are as follows:   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_READ   = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_WRITE  = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_BOTH   = 0x00000003;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_NONE     = 0x00000000;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_READ     = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE    = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH     = 0x00000003;8.9.  OPEN/CLOSE Operations   To provide correct share semantics, a client MUST use the OPEN   operation to obtain the initial filehandle and indicate the desired   access and what if any access to deny.  Even if the client intends to   use a stateid of all 0's or all 1's, it must still obtain the   filehandle for the regular file with the OPEN operation so the   appropriate share semantics can be applied.  For clients that do not   have a deny mode built into their open programming interfaces, deny   equal to NONE should be used.   The OPEN operation with the CREATE flag, also subsumes the CREATE   operation for regular files as used in previous versions of the NFS   protocol.  This allows a create with a share to be done atomically.   The CLOSE operation removes all share locks held by the nfs_lockowner   on that file.  If record locks are held, the client SHOULD release   all locks before issuing a CLOSE.  The server MAY free all   outstanding locks on CLOSE but some servers may not support the CLOSE   of a file that still has record locks held.  The server MUST return   failure if any locks would exist after the CLOSE.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 65]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The LOOKUP operation will return a filehandle without establishing   any lock state on the server.  Without a valid stateid, the server   will assume the client has the least access.  For example, a file   opened with deny READ/WRITE cannot be accessed using a filehandle   obtained through LOOKUP because it would not have a valid stateid   (i.e. using a stateid of all bits 0 or all bits 1).8.10.  Open Upgrade and Downgrade   When an OPEN is done for a file and the lockowner for which the open   is being done already has the file open, the result is to upgrade the   open file status maintained on the server to include the access and   deny bits specified by the new OPEN as well as those for the existing   OPEN.  The result is that there is one open file, as far as the   protocol is concerned, and it includes the union of the access and   deny bits for all of the OPEN requests completed.  Only a single   CLOSE will be done to reset the effects of both OPEN's.  Note that   the client, when issuing the OPEN, may not know that the same file is   in fact being opened.  The above only applies if both OPEN's result   in the OPEN'ed object being designated by the same filehandle.   When the server chooses to export multiple filehandles corresponding   to the same file object and returns different filehandles on two   different OPEN's of the same file object, the server MUST NOT "OR"   together the access and deny bits and coalesce the two open files.   Instead the server must maintain separate OPEN's with separate   stateid's and will require separate CLOSE's to free them.   When multiple open files on the client are merged into a single open   file object on the server, the close of one of the open files (on the   client) may necessitate change of the access and deny status of the   open file on the server.  This is because the union of the access and   deny bits for the remaining open's may be smaller (i.e. a proper   subset) than previously.  The OPEN_DOWNGRADE operation is used to   make the necessary change and the client should use it to update the   server so that share reservation requests by other clients are   handled properly.8.11.  Short and Long Leases   When determining the time period for the server lease, the usual   lease tradeoffs apply.  Short leases are good for fast server   recovery at a cost of increased RENEW or READ (with zero length)   requests.  Longer leases are certainly kinder and gentler to large   internet servers trying to handle very large numbers of clients.  The   number of RENEW requests drop in proportion to the lease time.  The   disadvantages of long leases are slower recovery after server failure   (server must wait for leases to expire and grace period beforeShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 66]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   granting new lock requests) and increased file contention (if client   fails to transmit an unlock request then server must wait for lease   expiration before granting new locks).   Long leases are usable if the server is able to store lease state in   non-volatile memory.  Upon recovery, the server can reconstruct the   lease state from its non-volatile memory and continue operation with   its clients and therefore long leases are not an issue.8.12.  Clocks and Calculating Lease Expiration   To avoid the need for synchronized clocks, lease times are granted by   the server as a time delta.  However, there is a requirement that the   client and server clocks do not drift excessively over the duration   of the lock.  There is also the issue of propagation delay across the   network which could easily be several hundred milliseconds as well as   the possibility that requests will be lost and need to be   retransmitted.   To take propagation delay into account, the client should subtract it   from lease times (e.g. if the client estimates the one-way   propagation delay as 200 msec, then it can assume that the lease is   already 200 msec old when it gets it).  In addition, it will take   another 200 msec to get a response back to the server.  So the client   must send a lock renewal or write data back to the server 400 msec   before the lease would expire.8.13.  Migration, Replication and State   When responsibility for handling a given file system is transferred   to a new server (migration) or the client chooses to use an alternate   server (e.g. in response to server unresponsiveness) in the context   of file system replication, the appropriate handling of state shared   between the client and server (i.e. locks, leases, stateid's, and   clientid's) is as described below.  The handling differs between   migration and replication.  For related discussion of file server   state and recover of such see the sections under "File Locking and   Share Reservations"8.13.1.  Migration and State   In the case of migration, the servers involved in the migration of a   file system SHOULD transfer all server state from the original to the   new server.  This must be done in a way that is transparent to the   client.  This state transfer will ease the client's transition when a   file system migration occurs.  If the servers are successful in   transferring all state, the client will continue to use stateid's   assigned by the original server.  Therefore the new server mustShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 67]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   recognize these stateid's as valid.  This holds true for the clientid   as well.  Since responsibility for an entire file system is   transferred with a migration event, there is no possibility that   conflicts will arise on the new server as a result of the transfer of   locks.   As part of the transfer of information between servers, leases would   be transferred as well.  The leases being transferred to the new   server will typically have a different expiration time from those for   the same client, previously on the new server.  To maintain the   property that all leases on a given server for a given client expire   at the same time, the server should advance the expiration time to   the later of the leases being transferred or the leases already   present.  This allows the client to maintain lease renewal of both   classes without special effort.   The servers may choose not to transfer the state information upon   migration.  However, this choice is discouraged.  In this case, when   the client presents state information from the original server, the   client must be prepared to receive either NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID or   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID from the new server.  The client should then   recover its state information as it normally would in response to a   server failure.  The new server must take care to allow for the   recovery of state information as it would in the event of server   restart.8.13.2.  Replication and State   Since client switch-over in the case of replication is not under   server control, the handling of state is different.  In this case,   leases, stateid's and clientid's do not have validity across a   transition from one server to another.  The client must re-establish   its locks on the new server.  This can be compared to the re-   establishment of locks by means of reclaim-type requests after a   server reboot.  The difference is that the server has no provision to   distinguish requests reclaiming locks from those obtaining new locks   or to defer the latter.  Thus, a client re-establishing a lock on the   new server (by means of a LOCK or OPEN request), may have the   requests denied due to a conflicting lock.  Since replication is   intended for read-only use of filesystems, such denial of locks   should not pose large difficulties in practice.  When an attempt to   re-establish a lock on a new server is denied, the client should   treat the situation as if his original lock had been revoked.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 68]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20008.13.3.  Notification of Migrated Lease   In the case of lease renewal, the client may not be submitting   requests for a file system that has been migrated to another server.   This can occur because of the implicit lease renewal mechanism.  The   client renews leases for all file systems when submitting a request   to any one file system at the server.   In order for the client to schedule renewal of leases that may have   been relocated to the new server, the client must find out about   lease relocation before those leases expire.  To accomplish this, all   operations which implicitly renew leases for a client (i.e. OPEN,   CLOSE, READ, WRITE, RENEW, LOCK, LOCKT, LOCKU), will return the error   NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED if responsibility for any of the leases to be   renewed has been transferred to a new server.  This condition will   continue until the client receives an NFS4ERR_MOVED error and the   server receives the subsequent GETATTR(fs_locations) for an access to   each file system for which a lease has been moved to a new server.   When a client receives an NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED error, it should   perform some operation, such as a RENEW, on each file system   associated with the server in question.  When the client receives an   NFS4ERR_MOVED error, the client can follow the normal process to   obtain the new server information (through the fs_locations   attribute) and perform renewal of those leases on the new server.  If   the server has not had state transferred to it transparently, it will   receive either NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID or NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID from   the new server, as described above, and can then recover state   information as it does in the event of server failure.9.  Client-Side Caching   Client-side caching of data, of file attributes, and of file names is   essential to providing good performance with the NFS protocol.   Providing distributed cache coherence is a difficult problem and   previous versions of the NFS protocol have not attempted it.   Instead, several NFS client implementation techniques have been used   to reduce the problems that a lack of coherence poses for users.   These techniques have not been clearly defined by earlier protocol   specifications and it is often unclear what is valid or invalid   client behavior.   The NFS version 4 protocol uses many techniques similar to those that   have been used in previous protocol versions.  The NFS version 4   protocol does not provide distributed cache coherence.  However, it   defines a more limited set of caching guarantees to allow locks and   share reservations to be used without destructive interference from   client side caching.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 69]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   In addition, the NFS version 4 protocol introduces a delegation   mechanism which allows many decisions normally made by the server to   be made locally by clients.  This mechanism provides efficient   support of the common cases where sharing is infrequent or where   sharing is read-only.9.1.  Performance Challenges for Client-Side Caching   Caching techniques used in previous versions of the NFS protocol have   been successful in providing good performance.  However, several   scalability challenges can arise when those techniques are used with   very large numbers of clients.  This is particularly true when   clients are geographically distributed which classically increases   the latency for cache revalidation requests.   The previous versions of the NFS protocol repeat their file data   cache validation requests at the time the file is opened.  This   behavior can have serious performance drawbacks.  A common case is   one in which a file is only accessed by a single client.  Therefore,   sharing is infrequent.   In this case, repeated reference to the server to find that no   conflicts exist is expensive.  A better option with regards to   performance is to allow a client that repeatedly opens a file to do   so without reference to the server.  This is done until potentially   conflicting operations from another client actually occur.   A similar situation arises in connection with file locking.  Sending   file lock and unlock requests to the server as well as the read and   write requests necessary to make data caching consistent with the   locking semantics (see the section "Data Caching and File Locking")   can severely limit performance.  When locking is used to provide   protection against infrequent conflicts, a large penalty is incurred.   This penalty may discourage the use of file locking by applications.   The NFS version 4 protocol provides more aggressive caching   strategies with the following design goals:   o  Compatibility with a large range of server semantics.   o  Provide the same caching benefits as previous versions of the NFS      protocol when unable to provide the more aggressive model.   o  Requirements for aggressive caching are organized so that a large      portion of the benefit can be obtained even when not all of the      requirements can be met.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 70]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The appropriate requirements for the server are discussed in later   sections in which specific forms of caching are covered. (see the   section "Open Delegation").9.2.  Delegation and Callbacks   Recallable delegation of server responsibilities for a file to a   client improves performance by avoiding repeated requests to the   server in the absence of inter-client conflict.  With the use of a   "callback" RPC from server to client, a server recalls delegated   responsibilities when another client engages in sharing of a   delegated file.   A delegation is passed from the server to the client, specifying the   object of the delegation and the type of delegation.  There are   different types of delegations but each type contains a stateid to be   used to represent the delegation when performing operations that   depend on the delegation.  This stateid is similar to those   associated with locks and share reservations but differs in that the   stateid for a delegation is associated with a clientid and may be   used on behalf of all the nfs_lockowners for the given client.  A   delegation is made to the client as a whole and not to any specific   process or thread of control within it.   Because callback RPCs may not work in all environments (due to   firewalls, for example), correct protocol operation does not depend   on them.  Preliminary testing of callback functionality by means of a   CB_NULL procedure determines whether callbacks can be supported.  The   CB_NULL procedure checks the continuity of the callback path.  A   server makes a preliminary assessment of callback availability to a   given client and avoids delegating responsibilities until it has   determined that callbacks are supported.  Because the granting of a   delegation is always conditional upon the absence of conflicting   access, clients must not assume that a delegation will be granted and   they must always be prepared for OPENs to be processed without any   delegations being granted.   Once granted, a delegation behaves in most ways like a lock.  There   is an associated lease that is subject to renewal together with all   of the other leases held by that client.   Unlike locks, an operation by a second client to a delegated file   will cause the server to recall a delegation through a callback.   On recall, the client holding the delegation must flush modified   state (such as modified data) to the server and return the   delegation.  The conflicting request will not receive a response   until the recall is complete.  The recall is considered complete whenShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 71]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   the client returns the delegation or the server times out on the   recall and revokes the delegation as a result of the timeout.   Following the resolution of the recall, the server has the   information necessary to grant or deny the second client's request.   At the time the client receives a delegation recall, it may have   substantial state that needs to be flushed to the server.  Therefore,   the server should allow sufficient time for the delegation to be   returned since it may involve numerous RPCs to the server.  If the   server is able to determine that the client is diligently flushing   state to the server as a result of the recall, the server may extend   the usual time allowed for a recall.  However, the time allowed for   recall completion should not be unbounded.   An example of this is when responsibility to mediate opens on a given   file is delegated to a client (see the section "Open Delegation").   The server will not know what opens are in effect on the client.   Without this knowledge the server will be unable to determine if the   access and deny state for the file allows any particular open until   the delegation for the file has been returned.   A client failure or a network partition can result in failure to   respond to a recall callback. In this case, the server will revoke   the delegation which in turn will render useless any modified state   still on the client.9.2.1.  Delegation Recovery   There are three situations that delegation recovery must deal with:   o  Client reboot or restart   o  Server reboot or restart   o  Network partition (full or callback-only)   In the event the client reboots or restarts, the failure to renew   leases will result in the revocation of record locks and share   reservations.  Delegations, however, may be treated a bit   differently.   There will be situations in which delegations will need to be   reestablished after a client reboots or restarts.  The reason for   this is the client may have file data stored locally and this data   was associated with the previously held delegations.  The client will   need to reestablish the appropriate file state on the server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 72]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   To allow for this type of client recovery, the server may extend the   period for delegation recovery beyond the typical lease expiration   period.  This implies that requests from other clients that conflict   with these delegations will need to wait.  Because the normal recall   process may require significant time for the client to flush changed   state to the server, other clients need be prepared for delays that   occur because of a conflicting delegation.  This longer interval   would increase the window for clients to reboot and consult stable   storage so that the delegations can be reclaimed.  For open   delegations, such delegations are reclaimed using OPEN with a claim   type of CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV.  (see the sections on "Data Caching and   Revocation" and "Operation 18: OPEN" for discussion of open   delegation and the details of OPEN respectively).   When the server reboots or restarts, delegations are reclaimed (using   the OPEN operation with CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV) in a similar fashion to   record locks and share reservations.  However, there is a slight   semantic difference.  In the normal case if the server decides that a   delegation should not be granted, it performs the requested action   (e.g. OPEN) without granting any delegation.  For reclaim, the server   grants the delegation but a special designation is applied so that   the client treats the delegation as having been granted but recalled   by the server.  Because of this, the client has the duty to write all   modified state to the server and then return the delegation.  This   process of handling delegation reclaim reconciles three principles of   the NFS Version 4 protocol:   o  Upon reclaim, a client reporting resources assigned to it by an      earlier server instance must be granted those resources.   o  The server has unquestionable authority to determine whether      delegations are to be granted and, once granted, whether they are      to be continued.   o  The use of callbacks is not to be depended upon until the client      has proven its ability to receive them.   When a network partition occurs, delegations are subject to freeing   by the server when the lease renewal period expires.  This is similar   to the behavior for locks and share reservations.  For delegations,   however, the server may extend the period in which conflicting   requests are held off.  Eventually the occurrence of a conflicting   request from another client will cause revocation of the delegation.   A loss of the callback path (e.g. by later network configuration   change) will have the same effect.  A recall request will fail and   revocation of the delegation will result.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 73]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   A client normally finds out about revocation of a delegation when it   uses a stateid associated with a delegation and receives the error   NFS4ERR_EXPIRED.  It also may find out about delegation revocation   after a client reboot when it attempts to reclaim a delegation and   receives that same error.  Note that in the case of a revoked write   open delegation, there are issues because data may have been modified   by the client whose delegation is revoked and separately by other   clients.  See the section "Revocation Recovery for Write Open   Delegation" for a discussion of such issues.  Note also that when   delegations are revoked, information about the revoked delegation   will be written by the server to stable storage (as described in the   section "Crash Recovery").  This is done to deal with the case in   which a server reboots after revoking a delegation but before the   client holding the revoked delegation is notified about the   revocation.9.3.  Data Caching   When applications share access to a set of files, they need to be   implemented so as to take account of the possibility of conflicting   access by another application.  This is true whether the applications   in question execute on different clients or reside on the same   client.   Share reservations and record locks are the facilities the NFS   version 4 protocol provides to allow applications to coordinate   access by providing mutual exclusion facilities.  The NFS version 4   protocol's data caching must be implemented such that it does not   invalidate the assumptions that those using these facilities depend   upon.9.3.1.  Data Caching and OPENs   In order to avoid invalidating the sharing assumptions that   applications rely on, NFS version 4 clients should not provide cached   data to applications or modify it on behalf of an application when it   would not be valid to obtain or modify that same data via a READ or   WRITE operation.   Furthermore, in the absence of open delegation (see the section "Open   Delegation") two additional rules apply.  Note that these rules are   obeyed in practice by many NFS version 2 and version 3 clients.   o  First, cached data present on a client must be revalidated after      doing an OPEN.  This is to ensure that the data for the OPENed      file is still correctly reflected in the client's cache.  This      validation must be done at least when the client's OPEN operation      includes DENY=WRITE or BOTH thus terminating a period in whichShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 74]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      other clients may have had the opportunity to open the file with      WRITE access.  Clients may choose to do the revalidation more      often (i.e. at OPENs specifying DENY=NONE) to parallel the NFS      version 3 protocol's practice for the benefit of users assuming      this degree of cache revalidation.   o  Second, modified data must be flushed to the server before closing      a file OPENed for write.  This is complementary to the first rule.      If the data is not flushed at CLOSE, the revalidation done after      client OPENs as file is unable to achieve its purpose.  The other      aspect to flushing the data before close is that the data must be      committed to stable storage, at the server, before the CLOSE      operation is requested by the client.  In the case of a server      reboot or restart and a CLOSEd file, it may not be possible to      retransmit the data to be written to the file.  Hence, this      requirement.9.3.2.  Data Caching and File Locking   For those applications that choose to use file locking instead of   share reservations to exclude inconsistent file access, there is an   analogous set of constraints that apply to client side data caching.   These rules are effective only if the file locking is used in a way   that matches in an equivalent way the actual READ and WRITE   operations executed.  This is as opposed to file locking that is   based on pure convention.  For example, it is possible to manipulate   a two-megabyte file by dividing the file into two one-megabyte   regions and protecting access to the two regions by file locks on   bytes zero and one.  A lock for write on byte zero of the file would   represent the right to do READ and WRITE operations on the first   region.  A lock for write on byte one of the file would represent the   right to do READ and WRITE operations on the second region.  As long   as all applications manipulating the file obey this convention, they   will work on a local file system.  However, they may not work with   the NFS version 4 protocol unless clients refrain from data caching.   The rules for data caching in the file locking environment are:   o  First, when a client obtains a file lock for a particular region,      the data cache corresponding to that region (if any cache data      exists) must be revalidated.  If the change attribute indicates      that the file may have been updated since the cached data was      obtained, the client must flush or invalidate the cached data for      the newly locked region.  A client might choose to invalidate all      of non-modified cached data that it has for the file but the only      requirement for correct operation is to invalidate all of the data      in the newly locked region.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 75]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  Second, before releasing a write lock for a region, all modified      data for that region must be flushed to the server.  The modified      data must also be written to stable storage.   Note that flushing data to the server and the invalidation of cached   data must reflect the actual byte ranges locked or unlocked.   Rounding these up or down to reflect client cache block boundaries   will cause problems if not carefully done.  For example, writing a   modified block when only half of that block is within an area being   unlocked may cause invalid modification to the region outside the   unlocked area.  This, in turn, may be part of a region locked by   another client.  Clients can avoid this situation by synchronously   performing portions of write operations that overlap that portion   (initial or final) that is not a full block.  Similarly, invalidating   a locked area which is not an integral number of full buffer blocks   would require the client to read one or two partial blocks from the   server if the revalidation procedure shows that the data which the   client possesses may not be valid.   The data that is written to the server as a pre-requisite to the   unlocking of a region must be written, at the server, to stable   storage.  The client may accomplish this either with synchronous   writes or by following asynchronous writes with a COMMIT operation.   This is required because retransmission of the modified data after a   server reboot might conflict with a lock held by another client.   A client implementation may choose to accommodate applications which   use record locking in non-standard ways (e.g. using a record lock as   a global semaphore) by flushing to the server more data upon an LOCKU   than is covered by the locked range.  This may include modified data   within files other than the one for which the unlocks are being done.   In such cases, the client must not interfere with applications whose   READs and WRITEs are being done only within the bounds of record   locks which the application holds.  For example, an application locks   a single byte of a file and proceeds to write that single byte.  A   client that chose to handle a LOCKU by flushing all modified data to   the server could validly write that single byte in response to an   unrelated unlock.  However, it would not be valid to write the entire   block in which that single written byte was located since it includes   an area that is not locked and might be locked by another client.   Client implementations can avoid this problem by dividing files with   modified data into those for which all modifications are done to   areas covered by an appropriate record lock and those for which there   are modifications not covered by a record lock.  Any writes done for   the former class of files must not include areas not locked and thus   not modified on the client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 76]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20009.3.3.  Data Caching and Mandatory File Locking   Client side data caching needs to respect mandatory file locking when   it is in effect.  The presence of mandatory file locking for a given   file is indicated in the result flags for an OPEN.  When mandatory   locking is in effect for a file, the client must check for an   appropriate file lock for data being read or written.  If a lock   exists for the range being read or written, the client may satisfy   the request using the client's validated cache.  If an appropriate   file lock is not held for the range of the read or write, the read or   write request must not be satisfied by the client's cache and the   request must be sent to the server for processing.  When a read or   write request partially overlaps a locked region, the request should   be subdivided into multiple pieces with each region (locked or not)   treated appropriately.9.3.4.  Data Caching and File Identity   When clients cache data, the file data needs to organized according   to the file system object to which the data belongs.  For NFS version   3 clients, the typical practice has been to assume for the purpose of   caching that distinct filehandles represent distinct file system   objects.  The client then has the choice to organize and maintain the   data cache on this basis.   In the NFS version 4 protocol, there is now the possibility to have   significant deviations from a "one filehandle per object" model   because a filehandle may be constructed on the basis of the object's   pathname.  Therefore, clients need a reliable method to determine if   two filehandles designate the same file system object.  If clients   were simply to assume that all distinct filehandles denote distinct   objects and proceed to do data caching on this basis, caching   inconsistencies would arise between the distinct client side objects   which mapped to the same server side object.   By providing a method to differentiate filehandles, the NFS version 4   protocol alleviates a potential functional regression in comparison   with the NFS version 3 protocol.  Without this method, caching   inconsistencies within the same client could occur and this has not   been present in previous versions of the NFS protocol.  Note that it   is possible to have such inconsistencies with applications executing   on multiple clients but that is not the issue being addressed here.   For the purposes of data caching, the following steps allow an NFS   version 4 client to determine whether two distinct filehandles denote   the same server side object:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 77]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  If GETATTR directed to two filehandles have different values of      the fsid attribute, then the filehandles represent distinct      objects.   o  If GETATTR for any file with an fsid that matches the fsid of the      two filehandles in question returns a unique_handles attribute      with a value of TRUE, then the two objects are distinct.   o  If GETATTR directed to the two filehandles does not return the      fileid attribute for one or both of the handles, then the it      cannot be determined whether the two objects are the same.      Therefore, operations which depend on that knowledge (e.g.  client      side data caching) cannot be done reliably.   o  If GETATTR directed to the two filehandles returns different      values for the fileid attribute, then they are distinct objects.   o  Otherwise they are the same object.9.4.  Open Delegation   When a file is being OPENed, the server may delegate further handling   of opens and closes for that file to the opening client.  Any such   delegation is recallable, since the circumstances that allowed for   the delegation are subject to change.  In particular, the server may   receive a conflicting OPEN from another client, the server must   recall the delegation before deciding whether the OPEN from the other   client may be granted.  Making a delegation is up to the server and   clients should not assume that any particular OPEN either will or   will not result in an open delegation.  The following is a typical   set of conditions that servers might use in deciding whether OPEN   should be delegated:   o  The client must be able to respond to the server's callback      requests.  The server will use the CB_NULL procedure for a test of      callback ability.   o  The client must have responded properly to previous recalls.   o  There must be no current open conflicting with the requested      delegation.   o  There should be no current delegation that conflicts with the      delegation being requested.   o  The probability of future conflicting open requests should be low      based on the recent history of the file.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 78]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  The existence of any server-specific semantics of OPEN/CLOSE that      would make the required handling incompatible with the prescribed      handling that the delegated client would apply (see below).   There are two types of open delegations, read and write.  A read open   delegation allows a client to handle, on its own, requests to open a   file for reading that do not deny read access to others.  Multiple   read open delegations may be outstanding simultaneously and do not   conflict.  A write open delegation allows the client to handle, on   its own, all opens.  Only one write open delegation may exist for a   given file at a given time and it is inconsistent with any read open   delegations.   When a client has a read open delegation, it may not make any changes   to the contents or attributes of the file but it is assured that no   other client may do so.  When a client has a write open delegation,   it may modify the file data since no other client will be accessing   the file's data.  The client holding a write delegation may only   affect file attributes which are intimately connected with the file   data:  object_size, time_modify, change.   When a client has an open delegation, it does not send OPENs or   CLOSEs to the server but updates the appropriate status internally.   For a read open delegation, opens that cannot be handled locally   (opens for write or that deny read access) must be sent to the   server.   When an open delegation is made, the response to the OPEN contains an   open delegation structure which specifies the following:   o  the type of delegation (read or write)   o  space limitation information to control flushing of data on close      (write open delegation only, see the section "Open Delegation and      Data Caching")   o  an nfsace4 specifying read and write permissions   o  a stateid to represent the delegation for READ and WRITE   The stateid is separate and distinct from the stateid for the OPEN   proper.  The standard stateid, unlike the delegation stateid, is   associated with a particular nfs_lockowner and will continue to be   valid after the delegation is recalled and the file remains open.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 79]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   When a request internal to the client is made to open a file and open   delegation is in effect, it will be accepted or rejected solely on   the basis of the following conditions.  Any requirement for other   checks to be made by the delegate should result in open delegation   being denied so that the checks can be made by the server itself.   o  The access and deny bits for the request and the file as described      in the section "Share Reservations".   o  The read and write permissions as determined below.   The nfsace4 passed with delegation can be used to avoid frequent   ACCESS calls.  The permission check should be as follows:   o  If the nfsace4 indicates that the open may be done, then it should      be granted without reference to the server.   o  If the nfsace4 indicates that the open may not be done, then an      ACCESS request must be sent to the server to obtain the definitive      answer.   The server may return an nfsace4 that is more restrictive than the   actual ACL of the file.  This includes an nfsace4 that specifies   denial of all access.  Note that some common practices such as   mapping the traditional user "root" to the user "nobody" may make it   incorrect to return the actual ACL of the file in the delegation   response.   The use of delegation together with various other forms of caching   creates the possibility that no server authentication will ever be   performed for a given user since all of the user's requests might be   satisfied locally.  Where the client is depending on the server for   authentication, the client should be sure authentication occurs for   each user by use of the ACCESS operation.  This should be the case   even if an ACCESS operation would not be required otherwise.  As   mentioned before, the server may enforce frequent authentication by   returning an nfsace4 denying all access with every open delegation.9.4.1.  Open Delegation and Data Caching   OPEN delegation allows much of the message overhead associated with   the opening and closing files to be eliminated.  An open when an open   delegation is in effect does not require that a validation message be   sent to the server.  The continued endurance of the "read open   delegation" provides a guarantee that no OPEN for write and thus no   write has occurred.  Similarly, when closing a file opened for write   and if write open delegation is in effect, the data written does not   have to be flushed to the server until the open delegation isShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 80]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   recalled.  The continued endurance of the open delegation provides a   guarantee that no open and thus no read or write has been done by   another client.   For the purposes of open delegation, READs and WRITEs done without an   OPEN are treated as the functional equivalents of a corresponding   type of OPEN.  This refers to the READs and WRITEs that use the   special stateids consisting of all zero bits or all one bits.   Therefore, READs or WRITEs with a special stateid done by another   client will force the server to recall a write open delegation.  A   WRITE with a special stateid done by another client will force a   recall of read open delegations.   With delegations, a client is able to avoid writing data to the   server when the CLOSE of a file is serviced.  The CLOSE operation is   the usual point at which the client is notified of a lack of stable   storage for the modified file data generated by the application.  At   the CLOSE, file data is written to the server and through normal   accounting the server is able to determine if the available file   system space for the data has been exceeded (i.e. server returns   NFS4ERR_NOSPC or NFS4ERR_DQUOT).  This accounting includes quotas.   The introduction of delegations requires that a alternative method be   in place for the same type of communication to occur between client   and server.   In the delegation response, the server provides either the limit of   the size of the file or the number of modified blocks and associated   block size.  The server must ensure that the client will be able to   flush data to the server of a size equal to that provided in the   original delegation.  The server must make this assurance for all   outstanding delegations.  Therefore, the server must be careful in   its management of available space for new or modified data taking   into account available file system space and any applicable quotas.   The server can recall delegations as a result of managing the   available file system space.  The client should abide by the server's   state space limits for delegations.  If the client exceeds the stated   limits for the delegation, the server's behavior is undefined.   Based on server conditions, quotas or available file system space,   the server may grant write open delegations with very restrictive   space limitations.  The limitations may be defined in a way that will   always force modified data to be flushed to the server on close.   With respect to authentication, flushing modified data to the server   after a CLOSE has occurred may be problematic.  For example, the user   of the application may have logged off of the client and unexpired   authentication credentials may not be present.  In this case, the   client may need to take special care to ensure that local unexpiredShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 81]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   credentials will in fact be available.  This may be accomplished by   tracking the expiration time of credentials and flushing data well in   advance of their expiration or by making private copies of   credentials to assure their availability when needed.9.4.2.  Open Delegation and File Locks   When a client holds a write open delegation, lock operations are   performed locally.  This includes those required for mandatory file   locking.  This can be done since the delegation implies that there   can be no conflicting locks.  Similarly, all of the revalidations   that would normally be associated with obtaining locks and the   flushing of data associated with the releasing of locks need not be   done.9.4.3.  Recall of Open Delegation   The following events necessitate recall of an open delegation:   o  Potentially conflicting OPEN request (or READ/WRITE done with      "special" stateid)   o  SETATTR issued by another client   o  REMOVE request for the file   o  RENAME request for the file as either source or target of the      RENAME   Whether a RENAME of a directory in the path leading to the file   results in recall of an open delegation depends on the semantics of   the server file system.  If that file system denies such RENAMEs when   a file is open, the recall must be performed to determine whether the   file in question is, in fact, open.   In addition to the situations above, the server may choose to recall   open delegations at any time if resource constraints make it   advisable to do so.  Clients should always be prepared for the   possibility of recall.   The server needs to employ special handling for a GETATTR where the   target is a file that has a write open delegation in effect.  In this   case, the client holding the delegation needs to be interrogated.   The server will use a CB_GETATTR callback, if the GETATTR attribute   bits include any of the attributes that a write open delegate may   modify (object_size, time_modify, change).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 82]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   When a client receives a recall for an open delegation, it needs to   update state on the server before returning the delegation.  These   same updates must be done whenever a client chooses to return a   delegation voluntarily.  The following items of state need to be   dealt with:   o  If the file associated with the delegation is no longer open and      no previous CLOSE operation has been sent to the server, a CLOSE      operation must be sent to the server.   o  If a file has other open references at the client, then OPEN      operations must be sent to the server.  The appropriate stateids      will be provided by the server for subsequent use by the client      since the delegation stateid will not longer be valid.  These OPEN      requests are done with the claim type of CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR.  This      will allow the presentation of the delegation stateid so that the      client can establish the appropriate rights to perform the OPEN.      (see the section "Operation 18: OPEN" for details.)   o  If there are granted file locks, the corresponding LOCK operations      need to be performed.  This applies to the write open delegation      case only.   o  For a write open delegation, if at the time of recall the file is      not open for write, all modified data for the file must be flushed      to the server.  If the delegation had not existed, the client      would have done this data flush before the CLOSE operation.   o  For a write open delegation when a file is still open at the time      of recall, any modified data for the file needs to be flushed to      the server.   o  With the write open delegation in place, it is possible that the      file was truncated during the duration of the delegation.  For      example, the truncation could have occurred as a result of an OPEN      UNCHECKED with a object_size attribute value of zero.  Therefore,      if a truncation of the file has occurred and this operation has      not been propagated to the server, the truncation must occur      before any modified data is written to the server.   In the case of write open delegation, file locking imposes some   additional requirements.  The flushing of any modified data in any   region for which a write lock was released while the write open   delegation was in effect is what is required to precisely maintain   the associated invariant.  However, because the write open delegation   implies no other locking by other clients, a simpler implementationShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 83]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   is to flush all modified data for the file (as described just above)   if any write lock has been released while the write open delegation   was in effect.9.4.4.  Delegation Revocation   At the point a delegation is revoked, if there are associated opens   on the client, the applications holding these opens need to be   notified.  This notification usually occurs by returning errors for   READ/WRITE operations or when a close is attempted for the open file.   If no opens exist for the file at the point the delegation is   revoked, then notification of the revocation is unnecessary.   However, if there is modified data present at the client for the   file, the user of the application should be notified.  Unfortunately,   it may not be possible to notify the user since active applications   may not be present at the client.  See the section "Revocation   Recovery for Write Open Delegation" for additional details.9.5.  Data Caching and Revocation   When locks and delegations are revoked, the assumptions upon which   successful caching depend are no longer guaranteed.  The owner of the   locks or share reservations which have been revoked needs to be   notified.  This notification includes applications with a file open   that has a corresponding delegation which has been revoked.  Cached   data associated with the revocation must be removed from the client.   In the case of modified data existing in the client's cache, that   data must be removed from the client without it being written to the   server.  As mentioned, the assumptions made by the client are no   longer valid at the point when a lock or delegation has been revoked.   For example, another client may have been granted a conflicting lock   after the revocation of the lock at the first client.  Therefore, the   data within the lock range may have been modified by the other   client.  Obviously, the first client is unable to guarantee to the   application what has occurred to the file in the case of revocation.   Notification to a lock owner will in many cases consist of simply   returning an error on the next and all subsequent READs/WRITEs to the   open file or on the close.  Where the methods available to a client   make such notification impossible because errors for certain   operations may not be returned, more drastic action such as signals   or process termination may be appropriate.  The justification for   this is that an invariant for which an application depends on may be   violated.  Depending on how errors are typically treated for the   client operating environment, further levels of notification   including logging, console messages, and GUI pop-ups may be   appropriate.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 84]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 20009.5.1.  Revocation Recovery for Write Open Delegation   Revocation recovery for a write open delegation poses the special   issue of modified data in the client cache while the file is not   open.  In this situation, any client which does not flush modified   data to the server on each close must ensure that the user receives   appropriate notification of the failure as a result of the   revocation.  Since such situations may require human action to   correct problems, notification schemes in which the appropriate user   or administrator is notified may be necessary.  Logging and console   messages are typical examples.   If there is modified data on the client, it must not be flushed   normally to the server.  A client may attempt to provide a copy of   the file data as modified during the delegation under a different   name in the file system name space to ease recovery.  Unless the   client can determine that the file has not modified by any other   client, this technique must be limited to situations in which a   client has a complete cached copy of the file in question.  Use of   such a technique may be limited to files under a certain size or may   only be used when sufficient disk space is guaranteed to be available   within the target file system and when the client has sufficient   buffering resources to keep the cached copy available until it is   properly stored to the target file system.9.6.  Attribute Caching   The attributes discussed in this section do not include named   attributes.  Individual named attributes are analogous to files and   caching of the data for these needs to be handled just as data   caching is for ordinary files.  Similarly, LOOKUP results from an   OPENATTR directory are to be cached on the same basis as any other   pathnames and similarly for directory contents.   Clients may cache file attributes obtained from the server and use   them to avoid subsequent GETATTR requests.  Such caching is write   through in that modification to file attributes is always done by   means of requests to the server and should not be done locally and   cached.  The exception to this are modifications to attributes that   are intimately connected with data caching.  Therefore, extending a   file by writing data to the local data cache is reflected immediately   in the object_size as seen on the client without this change being   immediately reflected on the server.  Normally such changes are not   propagated directly to the server but when the modified data is   flushed to the server, analogous attribute changes are made on the   server.  When open delegation is in effect, the modified attributes   may be returned to the server in the response to a CB_RECALL call.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 85]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   The result of local caching of attributes is that the attribute   caches maintained on individual clients will not be coherent. Changes   made in one order on the server may be seen in a different order on   one client and in a third order on a different client.   The typical file system application programming interfaces do not   provide means to atomically modify or interrogate attributes for   multiple files at the same time.  The following rules provide an   environment where the potential incoherences mentioned above can be   reasonably managed.  These rules are derived from the practice of   previous NFS protocols.   o  All attributes for a given file (per-fsid attributes excepted) are      cached as a unit at the client so that no non-serializability can      arise within the context of a single file.   o  An upper time boundary is maintained on how long a client cache      entry can be kept without being refreshed from the server.   o  When operations are performed that change attributes at the      server, the updated attribute set is requested as part of the      containing RPC.  This includes directory operations that update      attributes indirectly.  This is accomplished by following the      modifying operation with a GETATTR operation and then using the      results of the GETATTR to update the client's cached attributes.   Note that if the full set of attributes to be cached is requested by   READDIR, the results can be cached by the client on the same basis as   attributes obtained via GETATTR.   A client may validate its cached version of attributes for a file by   fetching only the change attribute and assuming that if the change   attribute has the same value as it did when the attributes were   cached, then no attributes have changed.  The possible exception is   the attribute time_access.9.7.  Name Caching   The results of LOOKUP and READDIR operations may be cached to avoid   the cost of subsequent LOOKUP operations.  Just as in the case of   attribute caching, inconsistencies may arise among the various client   caches.  To mitigate the effects of these inconsistencies and given   the context of typical file system APIs, the following rules should   be followed:   o  The results of unsuccessful LOOKUPs should not be cached, unless      they are specifically reverified at the point of use.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 86]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   o  An upper time boundary is maintained on how long a client name      cache entry can be kept without verifying that the entry has not      been made invalid by a directory change operation performed by      another client.   When a client is not making changes to a directory for which there   exist name cache entries, the client needs to periodically fetch   attributes for that directory to ensure that it is not being   modified.  After determining that no modification has occurred, the   expiration time for the associated name cache entries may be updated   to be the current time plus the name cache staleness bound.   When a client is making changes to a given directory, it needs to   determine whether there have been changes made to the directory by   other clients.  It does this by using the change attribute as   reported before and after the directory operation in the associated   change_info4 value returned for the operation.  The server is able to   communicate to the client whether the change_info4 data is provided   atomically with respect to the directory operation.  If the change   values are provided atomically, the client is then able to compare   the pre-operation change value with the change value in the client's   name cache.  If the comparison indicates that the directory was   updated by another client, the name cache associated with the   modified directory is purged from the client.  If the comparison   indicates no modification, the name cache can be updated on the   client to reflect the directory operation and the associated timeout   extended.  The post-operation change value needs to be saved as the   basis for future change_info4 comparisons.   As demonstrated by the scenario above, name caching requires that the   client revalidate name cache data by inspecting the change attribute   of a directory at the point when the name cache item was cached.   This requires that the server update the change attribute for   directories when the contents of the corresponding directory is   modified.  For a client to use the change_info4 information   appropriately and correctly, the server must report the pre and post   operation change attribute values atomically.  When the server is   unable to report the before and after values atomically with respect   to the directory operation, the server must indicate that fact in the   change_info4 return value.  When the information is not atomically   reported, the client should not assume that other clients have not   changed the directory.9.8.  Directory Caching   The results of READDIR operations may be used to avoid subsequent   READDIR operations.  Just as in the cases of attribute and name   caching, inconsistencies may arise among the various client caches.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 87]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   To mitigate the effects of these inconsistencies, and given the   context of typical file system APIs, the following rules should be   followed:   o  Cached READDIR information for a directory which is not obtained      in a single READDIR operation must always be a consistent snapshot      of directory contents.  This is determined by using a GETATTR      before the first READDIR and after the last of READDIR that      contributes to the cache.   o  An upper time boundary is maintained to indicate the length of      time a directory cache entry is considered valid before the client      must revalidate the cached information.   The revalidation technique parallels that discussed in the case of   name caching.  When the client is not changing the directory in   question, checking the change attribute of the directory with GETATTR   is adequate.  The lifetime of the cache entry can be extended at   these checkpoints.  When a client is modifying the directory, the   client needs to use the change_info4 data to determine whether there   are other clients modifying the directory.  If it is determined that   no other client modifications are occurring, the client may update   its directory cache to reflect its own changes.   As demonstrated previously, directory caching requires that the   client revalidate directory cache data by inspecting the change   attribute of a directory at the point when the directory was cached.   This requires that the server update the change attribute for   directories when the contents of the corresponding directory is   modified.  For a client to use the change_info4 information   appropriately and correctly, the server must report the pre and post   operation change attribute values atomically.  When the server is   unable to report the before and after values atomically with respect   to the directory operation, the server must indicate that fact in the   change_info4 return value.  When the information is not atomically   reported, the client should not assume that other clients have not   changed the directory.10.  Minor Versioning   To address the requirement of an NFS protocol that can evolve as the   need arises, the NFS version 4 protocol contains the rules and   framework to allow for future minor changes or versioning.   The base assumption with respect to minor versioning is that any   future accepted minor version must follow the IETF process and be   documented in a standards track RFC.  Therefore, each minor version   number will correspond to an RFC.  Minor version zero of the NFSShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 88]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   version 4 protocol is represented by this RFC.  The COMPOUND   procedure will support the encoding of the minor version being   requested by the client.   The following items represent the basic rules for the development of   minor versions.  Note that a future minor version may decide to   modify or add to the following rules as part of the minor version   definition.   1    Procedures are not added or deleted        To maintain the general RPC model, NFS version 4 minor versions        will not add or delete procedures from the NFS program.   2    Minor versions may add operations to the COMPOUND and        CB_COMPOUND procedures.        The addition of operations to the COMPOUND and CB_COMPOUND        procedures does not affect the RPC model.   2.1  Minor versions may append attributes to GETATTR4args, bitmap4,        and GETATTR4res.        This allows for the expansion of the attribute model to allow        for future growth or adaptation.   2.2  Minor version X must append any new attributes after the last        documented attribute.        Since attribute results are specified as an opaque array of        per-attribute XDR encoded results, the complexity of adding new        attributes in the midst of the current definitions will be too        burdensome.   3    Minor versions must not modify the structure of an existing        operation's arguments or results.        Again the complexity of handling multiple structure definitions        for a single operation is too burdensome.  New operations should        be added instead of modifying existing structures for a minor        version.        This rule does not preclude the following adaptations in a minor        version.        o  adding bits to flag fields such as new attributes to           GETATTR's bitmap4 data typeShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 89]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000        o  adding bits to existing attributes like ACLs that have flag           words        o  extending enumerated types (including NFS4ERR_*) with new           values   4    Minor versions may not modify the structure of existing        attributes.   5    Minor versions may not delete operations.        This prevents the potential reuse of a particular operation        "slot" in a future minor version.   6    Minor versions may not delete attributes.   7    Minor versions may not delete flag bits or enumeration values.   8    Minor versions may declare an operation as mandatory to NOT        implement.        Specifying an operation as "mandatory to not implement" is        equivalent to obsoleting an operation.  For the client, it means        that the operation should not be sent to the server.  For the        server, an NFS error can be returned as opposed to "dropping"        the request as an XDR decode error.  This approach allows for        the obsolescence of an operation while maintaining its structure        so that a future minor version can reintroduce the operation.   8.1  Minor versions may declare attributes mandatory to NOT        implement.   8.2  Minor versions may declare flag bits or enumeration values as        mandatory to NOT implement.   9    Minor versions may downgrade features from mandatory to        recommended, or recommended to optional.   10   Minor versions may upgrade features from optional to recommended        or recommended to mandatory.   11   A client and server that support minor version X must support        minor versions 0 (zero) through X-1 as well.   12   No new features may be introduced as mandatory in a minor        version.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 90]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000        This rule allows for the introduction of new functionality and        forces the use of implementation experience before designating a        feature as mandatory.   13   A client MUST NOT attempt to use a stateid, file handle, or        similar returned object from the COMPOUND procedure with minor        version X for another COMPOUND procedure with minor version Y,        where X != Y.11.  Internationalization   The primary issue in which NFS needs to deal with   internationalization, or I18n, is with respect to file names and   other strings as used within the protocol.  The choice of string   representation must allow reasonable name/string access to clients   which use various languages.  The UTF-8 encoding of the UCS as   defined by [ISO10646] allows for this type of access and follows the   policy described in "IETF Policy on Character Sets and Languages",   [RFC2277].  This choice is explained further in the following.11.1.  Universal Versus Local Character Sets   [RFC1345] describes a table of 16 bit characters for many different   languages (the bit encodings match Unicode, though of courseRFC1345   is somewhat out of date with respect to current Unicode assignments).   Each character from each language has a unique 16 bit value in the 16   bit character set.  Thus this table can be thought of as a universal   character set.  [RFC1345] then talks about groupings of subsets of   the entire 16 bit character set into "Charset Tables".  For example   one might take all the Greek characters from the 16 bit table (which   are consecutively allocated), and normalize their offsets to a table   that fits in 7 bits.  Thus it is determined that "lower case alpha"   is in the same position as "upper case a" in the US-ASCII table, and   "upper case alpha" is in the same position as "lower case a" in the   US-ASCII table.   These normalized subset character sets can be thought of as "local   character sets", suitable for an operating system locale.   Local character sets are not suitable for the NFS protocol.  Consider   someone who creates a file with a name in a Swedish character set.   If someone else later goes to access the file with their locale set   to the Swedish language, then there are no problems.  But if someone   in say the US-ASCII locale goes to access the file, the file name   will look very different, because the Swedish characters in the 7 bit   table will now be represented in US-ASCII characters on the display.   It would be preferable to give the US-ASCII user a way to display theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 91]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   file name using Swedish glyphs. In order to do that, the NFS protocol   would have to include the locale with the file name on each operation   to create a file.   But then what of the situation when there is a path name on the   server like:         /component-1/component-2/component-3   Each component could have been created with a different locale.  If   one issues CREATE with multi-component path name, and if some of the   leading components already exist, what is to be done with the   existing components?  Is the current locale attribute replaced with   the user's current one?  These types of situations quickly become too   complex when there is an alternate solution.   If the NFS version 4 protocol used a universal 16 bit or 32 bit   character set (or an encoding of a 16 bit or 32 bit character set   into octets), then the server and client need not care if the locale   of the user accessing the file is different than the locale of the   user who created the file.  The unique 16 bit or 32 bit encoding of   the character allows for determination of what language the character   is from and also how to display that character on the client.  The   server need not know what locales are used.11.2.  Overview of Universal Character Set Standards   The previous section makes a case for using a universal character   set.  This section makes the case for using UTF-8 as the specific   universal character set for the NFS version 4 protocol.   [RFC2279] discusses UTF-* (UTF-8 and other UTF-XXX encodings),   Unicode, and UCS-*.  There are two standards bodies managing   universal code sets:   o  ISO/IEC which has the standard 10646-1   o  Unicode which has the Unicode standard   Both standards bodies have pledged to track each other's assignments   of character codes.   The following is a brief analysis of the various standards.   UCS       Universal Character Set.  This is ISO/IEC 10646-1: "a             multi-octet character set called the Universal Character             Set (UCS), which encompasses most of the world's writing             systems."Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 92]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   UCS-2     a two octet per character encoding that addresses the first             2^16 characters of UCS. Currently there are no UCS             characters beyond that range.   UCS-4     a four octet per character encoding that permits the             encoding of up to 2^31 characters.   UTF       UTF is an abbreviation of the term "UCS transformation             format" and is used in the naming of various standards for             encoding of UCS characters as described below.   UTF-1     Only historical interest; it has been removed from 10646-1   UTF-7     Encodes the entire "repertoire" of UCS "characters using             only octets with the higher order bit clear".  [RFC2152]             describes UTF-7. UTF-7 accomplishes this by reserving one             of the 7bit US-ASCII characters as a "shift" character to             indicate non-US-ASCII characters.   UTF-8     Unlike UTF-7, uses all 8 bits of the octets. US-ASCII             characters are encoded as before unchanged. Any octet with             the high bit cleared can only mean a US-ASCII character.             The high bit set means that a UCS character is being             encoded.   UTF-16    Encodes UCS-4 characters into UCS-2 characters using a             reserved range in UCS-2.   Unicode   Unicode and UCS-2 are the same; [RFC2279] states:             Up to the present time, changes in Unicode and amendments             to ISO/IEC 10646 have tracked each other, so that the             character repertoires and code point assignments have             remained in sync.  The relevant standardization committees             have committed to maintain this very useful synchronism.11.3.  Difficulties with UCS-4, UCS-2, Unicode   Adapting existing applications, and file systems to multi-octet   schemes like UCS and Unicode can be difficult.  A significant amount   of code has been written to process streams of bytes. Also there are   many existing stored objects described with 7 bit or 8 bit   characters. Doubling or quadrupling the bandwidth and storage   requirements seems like an expensive way to accomplish I18N.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 93]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   UCS-2 and Unicode are "only" 16 bits long.  That might seem to be   enough but, according to [Unicode1], 49,194 Unicode characters are   already assigned.  According to [Unicode2] there are still more   languages that need to be added.11.4.  UTF-8 and its solutions   UTF-8 solves problems for NFS that exist with the use of UCS and   Unicode.  UTF-8 will encode 16 bit and 32 bit characters in a way   that will be compact for most users. The encoding table from UCS-4 to   UTF-8, as copied from [RFC2279]:      UCS-4 range (hex.)           UTF-8 octet sequence (binary)    0000 0000-0000 007F   0xxxxxxx    0000 0080-0000 07FF   110xxxxx 10xxxxxx    0000 0800-0000 FFFF   1110xxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx    0001 0000-001F FFFF   11110xxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx    0020 0000-03FF FFFF   111110xx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx    0400 0000-7FFF FFFF   1111110x 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx 10xxxxxx                          10xxxxxx   See [RFC2279] for precise encoding and decoding rules. Note because   of UTF-16, the algorithm from Unicode/UCS-2 to UTF-8 needs to account   for the reserved range between D800 and DFFF.   Note that the 16 bit UCS or Unicode characters require no more than 3   octets to encode into UTF-8   Interestingly, UTF-8 has room to handle characters larger than 31   bits, because the leading octet of form:         1111111x   is not defined. If needed, ISO could either use that octet to   indicate a sequence of an encoded 8 octet character, or perhaps use   11111110 to permit the next octet to indicate an even more expandable   character set.   So using UTF-8 to represent character encodings means never having to   run out of room.11.5.  Normalization   The client and server operating environments may differ in their   policies and operational methods with respect to character   normalization (See [Unicode1] for a discussion of normalization   forms).  This difference may also exist between applications on the   same client.  This adds to the difficulty of providing a singleShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 94]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   normalization policy for the protocol that allows for maximal   interoperability.  This issue is similar to the character case issues   where the server may or may not support case insensitive file name   matching and may or may not preserve the character case when storing   file names.  The protocol does not mandate a particular behavior but   allows for the various permutations.   The NFS version 4 protocol does not mandate the use of a particular   normalization form at this time.  A later revision of this   specification may specify a particular normalization form.   Therefore, the server and client can expect that they may receive   unnormalized characters within protocol requests and responses.  If   the operating environment requires normalization, then the   implementation must normalize the various UTF-8 encoded strings   within the protocol before presenting the information to an   application (at the client) or local file system (at the server).12.  Error Definitions   NFS error numbers are assigned to failed operations within a compound   request.  A compound request contains a number of NFS operations that   have their results encoded in sequence in a compound reply.  The   results of successful operations will consist of an NFS4_OK status   followed by the encoded results of the operation.  If an NFS   operation fails, an error status will be entered in the reply and the   compound request will be terminated.   A description of each defined error follows:   NFS4_OK               Indicates the operation completed successfully.   NFS4ERR_ACCES         Permission denied. The caller does not have the                         correct permission to perform the requested                         operation. Contrast this with NFS4ERR_PERM,                         which restricts itself to owner or privileged                         user permission failures.   NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE     Illegal NFS file handle. The file handle failed                         internal consistency checks.   NFS4ERR_BADTYPE       An attempt was made to create an object of a                         type not supported by the server.   NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE    READDIR cookie is stale.   NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID     The sequence number in a locking request is                         neither the next expected number or the last                         number processed.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 95]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID   A stateid generated by the current server                         instance, but which does not designate any                         locking state (either current or superseded)                         for a current lockowner-file pair, was used.   NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE    The SETCLIENTID procedure has found that a                         client id is already in use by another client.   NFS4ERR_DELAY         The server initiated the request, but was not                         able to complete it in a timely fashion. The                         client should wait and then try the request                         with a new RPC transaction ID.  For example,                         this error should be returned from a server                         that supports hierarchical storage and receives                         a request to process a file that has been                         migrated. In this case, the server should start                         the immigration process and respond to client                         with this error.  This error may also occur                         when a necessary delegation recall makes                         processing a request in a timely fashion                         impossible.   NFS4ERR_DENIED        An attempt to lock a file is denied.  Since                         this may be a temporary condition, the client                         is encouraged to retry the lock request until                         the lock is accepted.   NFS4ERR_DQUOT         Resource (quota) hard limit exceeded. The                         user's resource limit on the server has been                         exceeded.   NFS4ERR_EXIST         File exists. The file specified already exists.   NFS4ERR_EXPIRED       A lease has expired that is being used in the                         current procedure.   NFS4ERR_FBIG          File too large. The operation would have caused                         a file to grow beyond the server's limit.   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED     The file handle provided is volatile and has                         expired at the server.   NFS4ERR_GRACE         The server is in its recovery or grace period                         which should match the lease period of the                         server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 96]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   NFS4ERR_INVAL         Invalid argument or unsupported argument for an                         operation. Two examples are attempting a                         READLINK on an object other than a symbolic                         link or attempting to SETATTR a time field on a                         server that does not support this operation.   NFS4ERR_IO            I/O error. A hard error (for example, a disk                         error) occurred while processing the requested                         operation.   NFS4ERR_ISDIR         Is a directory. The caller specified a                         directory in a non-directory operation.   NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED   A lease being renewed is associated with a file                         system that has been migrated to a new server.   NFS4ERR_LOCKED        A read or write operation was attempted on a                         locked file.   NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE    A lock request is operating on a sub-range of a                         current lock for the lock owner and the server                         does not support this type of request.   NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH                         The server has received a request that                         specifies an unsupported minor version.  The                         server must return a COMPOUND4res with a zero                         length operations result array.   NFS4ERR_MLINK         Too many hard links.   NFS4ERR_MOVED         The filesystem which contains the current                         filehandle object has been relocated or                         migrated to another server.  The client may                         obtain the new filesystem location by obtaining                         the "fs_locations" attribute for the current                         filehandle.  For further discussion, refer to                         the section "Filesystem Migration or                         Relocation".   NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG   The filename in an operation was too long.   NFS4ERR_NODEV         No such device.   NFS4ERR_NOENT         No such file or directory. The file or                         directory name specified does not exist.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 97]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE  The logical current file handle value has not                         been set properly.  This may be a result of a                         malformed COMPOUND operation (i.e. no PUTFH or                         PUTROOTFH before an operation that requires the                         current file handle be set).   NFS4ERR_NOSPC         No space left on device. The operation would                         have caused the server's file system to exceed                         its limit.   NFS4ERR_NOTDIR        Not a directory. The caller specified a non-                         directory in a directory operation.   NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      An attempt was made to remove a directory that                         was not empty.   NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP       Operation is not supported.   NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME      This error is returned by the VERIFY operation                         to signify that the attributes compared were                         not the same as provided in the client's                         request.   NFS4ERR_NXIO          I/O error. No such device or address.   NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID   A stateid which designates the locking state                         for a lockowner-file at an earlier time was                         used.   NFS4ERR_PERM          Not owner. The operation was not allowed                         because the caller is either not a privileged                         user (root) or not the owner of the target of                         the operation.   NFS4ERR_READDIR_NOSPC The encoded response to a READDIR request                         exceeds the size limit set by the initial                         request.   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      For the processing of the COMPOUND procedure,                         the server may exhaust available resources and                         can not continue processing procedures within                         the COMPOUND operation.  This error will be                         returned from the server in those instances of                         resource exhaustion related to the processing                         of the COMPOUND procedure.   NFS4ERR_ROFS          Read-only file system. A modifying operation                         was attempted on a read-only file system.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 98]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   NFS4ERR_SAME          This error is returned by the NVERIFY operation                         to signify that the attributes compared were                         the same as provided in the client's request.   NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT   An error occurred on the server which does not                         map to any of the legal NFS version 4 protocol                         error values.  The client should translate this                         into an appropriate error.  UNIX clients may                         choose to translate this to EIO.   NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED  An attempt to OPEN a file with a share                         reservation has failed because of a share                         conflict.   NFS4ERR_STALE         Invalid file handle. The file handle given in                         the arguments was invalid. The file referred to                         by that file handle no longer exists or access                         to it has been revoked.   NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID A clientid not recognized by the server was                         used in a locking or SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM                         request.   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID A stateid generated by an earlier server                         instance was used.   NFS4ERR_SYMLINK       The current file handle provided for a LOOKUP                         is not a directory but a symbolic link.  Also                         used if the final component of the OPEN path is                         a symbolic link.                         NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL      Buffer or request is too                         small.   NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC      The security mechanism being used by the client                         for the procedure does not match the server's                         security policy.  The client should change the                         security mechanism being used and retry the                         operation.   NFS4ERR_XDEV          Attempt to do a cross-device hard link.13.  NFS Version 4 Requests   For the NFS version 4 RPC program, there are two traditional RPC   procedures: NULL and COMPOUND.  All other functionality is defined as   a set of operations and these operations are defined in normal   XDR/RPC syntax and semantics.  However, these operations areShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 99]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   encapsulated within the COMPOUND procedure.  This requires that the   client combine one or more of the NFS version 4 operations into a   single request.   The NFS4_CALLBACK program is used to provide server to client   signaling and is constructed in a similar fashion as the NFS version   4 program.  The procedures CB_NULL and CB_COMPOUND are defined in the   same way as NULL and COMPOUND are within the NFS program.  The   CB_COMPOUND request also encapsulates the remaining operations of the   NFS4_CALLBACK program.  There is no predefined RPC program number for   the NFS4_CALLBACK program.  It is up to the client to specify a   program number in the "transient" program range.  The program and   port number of the NFS4_CALLBACK program are provided by the client   as part of the SETCLIENTID operation and therefore is fixed for the   life of the client instantiation.13.1.  Compound Procedure   The COMPOUND procedure provides the opportunity for better   performance within high latency networks.  The client can avoid   cumulative latency of multiple RPCs by combining multiple dependent   operations into a single COMPOUND procedure.  A compound operation   may provide for protocol simplification by allowing the client to   combine basic procedures into a single request that is customized for   the client's environment.   The CB_COMPOUND procedure precisely parallels the features of   COMPOUND as described above.   The basics of the COMPOUND procedures construction is:                  +-----------+-----------+-----------+--                  | op + args | op + args | op + args |                  +-----------+-----------+-----------+--   and the reply looks like this:      +------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+--      |last status | status + op + results | status + op + results |      +------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+--13.2.  Evaluation of a Compound Request   The server will process the COMPOUND procedure by evaluating each of   the operations within the COMPOUND procedure in order.  Each   component operation consists of a 32 bit operation code, followed by   the argument of length determined by the type of operation. The   results of each operation are encoded in sequence into a replyShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 100]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   buffer.  The results of each operation are preceded by the opcode and   a status code (normally zero).  If an operation results in a non-zero   status code, the status will be encoded and evaluation of the   compound sequence will halt and the reply will be returned.  Note   that evaluation stops even in the event of "non error" conditions   such as NFS4ERR_SAME.   There are no atomicity requirements for the operations contained   within the COMPOUND procedure.  The operations being evaluated as   part of a COMPOUND request may be evaluated simultaneously with other   COMPOUND requests that the server receives.   It is the client's responsibility for recovering from any partially   completed COMPOUND procedure.  Partially completed COMPOUND   procedures may occur at any point due to errors such as   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE and NFS4ERR_LONG_DELAY.  This may occur even given   an otherwise valid operation string.  Further, a server reboot which   occurs in the middle of processing a COMPOUND procedure may leave the   client with the difficult task of determining how far COMPOUND   processing has proceeded.  Therefore, the client should avoid overly   complex COMPOUND procedures in the event of the failure of an   operation within the procedure.   Each operation assumes a "current" and "saved" filehandle that is   available as part of the execution context of the compound request.   Operations may set, change, or return the current filehandle.  The   "saved" filehandle is used for temporary storage of a filehandle   value and as operands for the RENAME and LINK operations.13.3.  Synchronous Modifying Operations   NFS version 4 operations that modify the file system are synchronous.   When an operation is successfully completed at the server, the client   can depend that any data associated with the request is now on stable   storage (the one exception is in the case of the file data in a WRITE   operation with the UNSTABLE option specified).   This implies that any previous operations within the same compound   request are also reflected in stable storage.  This behavior enables   the client's ability to recover from a partially executed compound   request which may resulted from the failure of the server.  For   example, if a compound request contains operations A and B and the   server is unable to send a response to the client, depending on the   progress the server made in servicing the request the result of both   operations may be reflected in stable storage or just operation A may   be reflected.  The server must not have just the results of operation   B in stable storage.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 101]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200013.4.  Operation Values   The operations encoded in the COMPOUND procedure are identified by   operation values.  To avoid overlap with the RPC procedure numbers,   operations 0 (zero) and 1 are not defined.  Operation 2 is not   defined but reserved for future use with minor versioning.14.  NFS Version 4 Procedures14.1.  Procedure 0: NULL - No Operation   SYNOPSIS      <null>   ARGUMENT      void;   RESULT      void;   DESCRIPTION      Standard NULL procedure.  Void argument, void response.  This      procedure has no functionality associated with it.  Because of      this it is sometimes used to measure the overhead of processing a      service request.  Therefore, the server should ensure that no      unnecessary work is done in servicing this procedure.   ERRORS      None.14.2.  Procedure 1: COMPOUND - Compound Operations   SYNOPSIS      compoundargs -> compoundres   ARGUMENT      union nfs_argop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 argop) {              case <OPCODE>: <argument>;              ...      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 102]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      struct COMPOUND4args {              utf8string      tag;              uint32_t        minorversion;              nfs_argop4      argarray<>;      };   RESULT         union nfs_resop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 resop){                 case <OPCODE>: <result>;                 ...         };         struct COMPOUND4res {                 nfsstat4        status;                 utf8string      tag;                 nfs_resop4      resarray<>;         };   DESCRIPTION      The COMPOUND procedure is used to combine one or more of the NFS      operations into a single RPC request.  The main NFS RPC program      has two main procedures: NULL and COMPOUND.  All other operations      use the COMPOUND procedure as a wrapper.      The COMPOUND procedure is used to combine individual operations      into a single RPC request.  The server interprets each of the      operations in turn.  If an operation is executed by the server and      the status of that operation is NFS4_OK, then the next operation      in the COMPOUND procedure is executed.  The server continues this      process until there are no more operations to be executed or one      of the operations has a status value other than NFS4_OK.      In the processing of the COMPOUND procedure, the server may find      that it does not have the available resources to execute any or      all of the operations within the COMPOUND sequence.  In this case,      the error NFS4ERR_RESOURCE will be returned for the particular      operation within the COMPOUND procedure where the resource      exhaustion occurred.  This assumes that all previous operations      within the COMPOUND sequence have been evaluated successfully.      The results for all of the evaluated operations must be returned      to the client.      The COMPOUND arguments contain a "minorversion" field.  The      initial and default value for this field is 0 (zero).  This field      will be used by future minor versions such that the client can      communicate to the server what minor version is being requested.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 103]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      If the server receives a COMPOUND procedure with a minorversion      field value that it does not support, the server MUST return an      error of NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH and a zero length resultdata      array.      Contained within the COMPOUND results is a "status" field.  If the      results array length is non-zero, this status must be equivalent      to the status of the last operation that was executed within the      COMPOUND procedure.  Therefore, if an operation incurred an error      then the "status" value will be the same error value as is being      returned for the operation that failed.      Note that operations, 0 (zero) and 1 (one) are not defined for the      COMPOUND procedure.  If the server receives an operation array      with either of these included, an error of NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP must be      returned.  Operation 2 is not defined but reserved for future      definition and use with minor versioning.  If the server receives      a operation array that contains operation 2 and the minorversion      field has a value of 0 (zero), an error of NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP is      returned.  If an operation array contains an operation 2 and the      minorversion field is non-zero and the server does not support the      minor version, the server returns an error of      NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH.  Therefore, the      NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH error takes precedence over all other      errors.   IMPLEMENTATION      Note that the definition of the "tag" in both the request and      response are left to the implementor.  It may be used to summarize      the content of the compound request for the benefit of packet      sniffers and engineers debugging implementations.      Since an error of any type may occur after only a portion of the      operations have been evaluated, the client must be prepared to      recover from any failure.  If the source of an NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      error was a complex or lengthy set of operations, it is likely      that if the number of operations were reduced the server would be      able to evaluate them successfully.  Therefore, the client is      responsible for dealing with this type of complexity in recovery.   ERRORS      All errors defined in the protocolShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 104]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.1.  Operation 3: ACCESS - Check Access Rights   SYNOPSIS         (cfh), accessreq -> supported, accessrights   ARGUMENT         const ACCESS4_READ      = 0x00000001;         const ACCESS4_LOOKUP    = 0x00000002;         const ACCESS4_MODIFY    = 0x00000004;         const ACCESS4_EXTEND    = 0x00000008;         const ACCESS4_DELETE    = 0x00000010;         const ACCESS4_EXECUTE   = 0x00000020;         struct ACCESS4args {                 /* CURRENT_FH: object */                 uint32_t        access;         };   RESULT         struct ACCESS4resok {                 uint32_t        supported;                 uint32_t        access;         };         union ACCESS4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                  ACCESS4resok   resok4;          default:                  void;         };   DESCRIPTION      ACCESS determines the access rights that a user, as identified by      the credentials in the RPC request, has with respect to the file      system object specified by the current filehandle.  The client      encodes the set of access rights that are to be checked in the bit      mask "access".  The server checks the permissions encoded in the      bit mask.  If a status of NFS4_OK is returned, two bit masks are      included in the response.  The first, "supported", represents the      access rights for which the server can verify reliably.  The      second, "access", represents the access rights available to the      user for the filehandle provided.  On success, the current      filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 105]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      Note that the supported field will contain only as many values as      was originally sent in the arguments.  For example, if the client      sends an ACCESS operation with only the ACCESS4_READ value set and      the server supports this value, the server will return only      ACCESS4_READ even if it could have reliably checked other values.      The results of this operation are necessarily advisory in nature.      A return status of NFS4_OK and the appropriate bit set in the bit      mask does not imply that such access will be allowed to the file      system object in the future. This is because access rights can be      revoked by the server at any time.      The following access permissions may be requested:   ACCESS4_READ    Read data from file or read a directory.   ACCESS4_LOOKUP  Look up a name in a directory (no meaning for non-                   directory objects).   ACCESS4_MODIFY  Rewrite existing file data or modify existing                   directory entries.   ACCESS4_EXTEND  Write new data or add directory entries.   ACCESS4_DELETE  Delete an existing directory entry (no meaning for                   non-directory objects).   ACCESS4_EXECUTE Execute file (no meaning for a directory).   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      For the NFS version 4 protocol, the use of the ACCESS procedure      when opening a regular file is deprecated in favor of using OPEN.      In general, it is not sufficient for the client to attempt to      deduce access permissions by inspecting the uid, gid, and mode      fields in the file attributes or by attempting to interpret the      contents of the ACL attribute.  This is because the server may      perform uid or gid mapping or enforce additional access control      restrictions.  It is also possible that the server may not be in      the same ID space as the client.  In these cases (and perhaps      others), the client can not reliably perform an access check with      only current file attributes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 106]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      In the NFS version 2 protocol, the only reliable way to determine      whether an operation was allowed was to try it and see if it      succeeded or failed.  Using the ACCESS procedure in the NFS      version 4 protocol, the client can ask the server to indicate      whether or not one or more classes of operations are permitted.      The ACCESS operation is provided to allow clients to check before      doing a series of operations which will result in an access      failure.  The OPEN operation provides a point where the server can      verify access to the file object and method to return that      information to the client.  The ACCESS operation is still useful      for directory operations or for use in the case the UNIX API      "access" is used on the client.      The information returned by the server in response to an ACCESS      call is not permanent.  It was correct at the exact time that the      server performed the checks, but not necessarily afterwards.  The      server can revoke access permission at any time.      The client should use the effective credentials of the user to      build the authentication information in the ACCESS request used to      determine access rights.  It is the effective user and group      credentials that are used in subsequent read and write operations.      Many implementations do not directly support the ACCESS4_DELETE      permission.  Operating systems like UNIX will ignore the      ACCESS4_DELETE bit if set on an access request on a non-directory      object.  In these systems, delete permission on a file is      determined by the access permissions on the directory in which the      file resides, instead of being determined by the permissions of      the file itself.  Therefore, the mask returned enumerating which      access rights can be determined will have the ACCESS4_DELETE value      set to 0.  This indicates to the client that the server was unable      to check that particular access right.  The ACCESS4_DELETE bit in      the access mask returned will then be ignored by the client.   ERRORS         NFS4ERR_ACCES         NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE         NFS4ERR_DELAY         NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED         NFS4ERR_IO         NFS4ERR_MOVED         NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT         NFS4ERR_STALE         NFS4ERR_WRONGSECShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 107]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.2.  Operation 4: CLOSE - Close File   SYNOPSIS         (cfh), seqid, stateid -> stateid   ARGUMENT         struct CLOSE4args {                 /* CURRENT_FH: object */                 seqid4          seqid                 stateid4        stateid;         };   RESULT         union CLOSE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                  stateid4       stateid;          default:                  void;         };   DESCRIPTION      The CLOSE operation releases share reservations for the file as      specified by the current filehandle.  The share reservations and      other state information released at the server as a result of this      CLOSE is only associated with the supplied stateid.  The sequence      id provides for the correct ordering. State associated with other      OPENs is not affected.      If record locks are held, the client SHOULD release all locks      before issuing a CLOSE.  The server MAY free all outstanding locks      on CLOSE but some servers may not support the CLOSE of a file that      still has record locks held.  The server MUST return failure if      any locks would exist after the CLOSE.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      ERRORS         NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE         NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID         NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID         NFS4ERR_DELAYShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 108]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         NFS4ERR_EXPIRED         NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED         NFS4ERR_GRACE         NFS4ERR_INVAL         NFS4ERR_ISDIR         NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED         NFS4ERR_MOVED         NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE         NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT         NFS4ERR_STALE         NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.3.  Operation 5: COMMIT - Commit Cached Data   SYNOPSIS         (cfh), offset, count -> verifier   ARGUMENT         struct COMMIT4args {                 /* CURRENT_FH: file */                 offset4         offset;                 count4          count;         };   RESULT         struct COMMIT4resok {                 verifier4       writeverf;         };         union COMMIT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                  COMMIT4resok   resok4;          default:                  void;         };   DESCRIPTION      The COMMIT operation forces or flushes data to stable storage for      the file specified by the current file handle.  The flushed data      is that which was previously written with a WRITE operation which      had the stable field set to UNSTABLE4.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 109]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The offset specifies the position within the file where the flush      is to begin.  An offset value of 0 (zero) means to flush data      starting at the beginning of the file.  The count specifies the      number of bytes of data to flush.  If count is 0 (zero), a flush      from offset to the end of the file is done.      The server returns a write verifier upon successful completion of      the COMMIT.  The write verifier is used by the client to determine      if the server has restarted or rebooted between the initial      WRITE(s) and the COMMIT.  The client does this by comparing the      write verifier returned from the initial writes and the verifier      returned by the COMMIT procedure.  The server must vary the value      of the write verifier at each server event or instantiation that      may lead to a loss of uncommitted data.  Most commonly this occurs      when the server is rebooted; however, other events at the server      may result in uncommitted data loss as well.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      The COMMIT procedure is similar in operation and semantics to the      POSIX fsync(2) system call that synchronizes a file's state with      the disk (file data and metadata is flushed to disk or stable      storage). COMMIT performs the same operation for a client,      flushing any unsynchronized data and metadata on the server to the      server's disk or stable storage for the specified file.  Like      fsync(2), it may be that there is some modified data or no      modified data to synchronize.  The data may have been synchronized      by the server's normal periodic buffer synchronization activity.      COMMIT should return NFS4_OK, unless there has been an unexpected      error.      COMMIT differs from fsync(2) in that it is possible for the client      to flush a range of the file (most likely triggered by a buffer-      reclamation scheme on the client before file has been completely      written).      The server implementation of COMMIT is reasonably simple.  If the      server receives a full file COMMIT request, that is starting at      offset 0 and count 0, it should do the equivalent of fsync()'ing      the file.  Otherwise, it should arrange to have the cached data in      the range specified by offset and count to be flushed to stable      storage.  In both cases, any metadata associated with the file      must be flushed to stable storage before returning.  It is not an      error for there to be nothing to flush on the server.  This means      that the data and metadata that needed to be flushed have already      been flushed or lost during the last server failure.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 110]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The client implementation of COMMIT is a little more complex.      There are two reasons for wanting to commit a client buffer to      stable storage.  The first is that the client wants to reuse a      buffer.  In this case, the offset and count of the buffer are sent      to the server in the COMMIT request.  The server then flushes any      cached data based on the offset and count, and flushes any      metadata associated with the file.  It then returns the status of      the flush and the write verifier.  The other reason for the client      to generate a COMMIT is for a full file flush, such as may be done      at close.  In this case, the client would gather all of the      buffers for this file that contain uncommitted data, do the COMMIT      operation with an offset of 0 and count of 0, and then free all of      those buffers.  Any other dirty buffers would be sent to the      server in the normal fashion.      After a buffer is written by the client with the stable parameter      set to UNSTABLE4, the buffer must be considered as modified by the      client until the buffer has either been flushed via a COMMIT      operation or written via a WRITE operation with stable parameter      set to FILE_SYNC4 or DATA_SYNC4. This is done to prevent the      buffer from being freed and reused before the data can be flushed      to stable storage on the server.      When a response is returned from either a WRITE or a COMMIT      operation and it contains a write verifier that is different than      previously returned by the server, the client will need to      retransmit all of the buffers containing uncommitted cached data      to the server.  How this is to be done is up to the implementor.      If there is only one buffer of interest, then it should probably      be sent back over in a WRITE request with the appropriate stable      parameter.  If there is more than one buffer, it might be      worthwhile retransmitting all of the buffers in WRITE requests      with the stable parameter set to UNSTABLE4 and then retransmitting      the COMMIT operation to flush all of the data on the server to      stable storage.  The timing of these retransmissions is left to      the implementor.      The above description applies to page-cache-based systems as well      as buffer-cache-based systems.  In those systems, the virtual      memory system will need to be modified instead of the buffer      cache.   ERRORS         NFS4ERR_ACCES         NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE         NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED         NFS4ERR_IOShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 111]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         NFS4ERR_ISDIR         NFS4ERR_LOCKED         NFS4ERR_MOVED         NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_ROFS         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT         NFS4ERR_STALE         NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.4.  Operation 6: CREATE - Create a Non-Regular File Object   SYNOPSIS         (cfh), name, type -> (cfh), change_info   ARGUMENT         union createtype4 switch (nfs_ftype4 type) {          case NF4LNK:                  linktext4      linkdata;          case NF4BLK:          case NF4CHR:                  specdata4      devdata;          case NF4SOCK:          case NF4FIFO:          case NF4DIR:                  void;         };         struct CREATE4args {                 /* CURRENT_FH: directory for creation */                 component4      objname;                 createtype4     objtype;         };   RESULT         struct CREATE4resok {                 change_info4     cinfo;         };         union CREATE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                  CREATE4resok resok4;          default:                  void;         };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 112]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   DESCRIPTION      The CREATE operation creates a non-regular file object in a      directory with a given name.  The OPEN procedure MUST be used to      create a regular file.      The objname specifies the name for the new object.  If the objname      has a length of 0 (zero), the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be      returned.  The objtype determines the type of object to be      created: directory, symlink, etc.      If an object of the same name already exists in the directory, the      server will return the error NFS4ERR_EXIST.      For the directory where the new file object was created, the      server returns change_info4 information in cinfo.  With the atomic      field of the change_info4 struct, the server will indicate if the      before and after change attributes were obtained atomically with      respect to the file object creation.      If the objname has a length of 0 (zero), or if objname does not      obey the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be      returned.      The current filehandle is replaced by that of the new object.   IMPLEMENTATION      If the client desires to set attribute values after the create, a      SETATTR operation can be added to the COMPOUND request so that the      appropriate attributes will be set.   ERRORS         NFS4ERR_ACCES         NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE         NFS4ERR_BADTYPE         NFS4ERR_DQUOT         NFS4ERR_EXIST         NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED         NFS4ERR_INVAL         NFS4ERR_IO         NFS4ERR_MOVED         NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG         NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE         NFS4ERR_NOSPC         NFS4ERR_NOTDIR         NFS4ERR_NOTSUPPShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 113]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_ROFS         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT         NFS4ERR_STALE         NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.5.  Operation 7: DELEGPURGE - Purge Delegations Awaiting Recovery   SYNOPSIS         clientid ->   ARGUMENT         struct DELEGPURGE4args {                 clientid4       clientid;        };   RESULT         struct DELEGPURGE4res {                 nfsstat4        status;         };   DESCRIPTION      Purges all of the delegations awaiting recovery for a given      client.  This is useful for clients which do not commit delegation      information to stable storage to indicate that conflicting      requests need not be delayed by the server awaiting recovery of      delegation information.      This operation should be used by clients that record delegation      information on stable storage on the client.  In this case,      DELEGPURGE should be issued immediately after doing delegation      recovery on all delegations know to the client.  Doing so will      notify the server that no additional delegations for the client      will be recovered allowing it to free resources, and avoid      delaying other clients who make requests that conflict with the      unrecovered delegations.  The set of delegations known to the      server and the client may be different.  The reason for this is      that a client may fail after making a request which resulted in      delegation but before it received the results and committed them      to the client's stable storage.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_RESOURCEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 114]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.6.  Operation 8: DELEGRETURN - Return Delegation   SYNOPSIS         stateid ->   ARGUMENT         struct DELEGRETURN4args {                 stateid4        stateid;         };   RESULT         struct DELEGRETURN4res {                 nfsstat4        status;         };   DESCRIPTION      Returns the delegation represented by the given stateid.   ERRORS         NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID         NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT         NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.7.  Operation 9: GETATTR - Get Attributes   SYNOPSIS         (cfh), attrbits -> attrbits, attrvals   ARGUMENT         struct GETATTR4args {                 /* CURRENT_FH: directory or file */                 bitmap4         attr_request;         };   RESULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 115]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         struct GETATTR4resok {                 fattr4          obj_attributes;         };         union GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                  GETATTR4resok  resok4;          default:                  void;         };   DESCRIPTION      The GETATTR operation will obtain attributes for the file system      object specified by the current filehandle.  The client sets a bit      in the bitmap argument for each attribute value that it would like      the server to return.  The server returns an attribute bitmap that      indicates the attribute values for which it was able to return,      followed by the attribute values ordered lowest attribute number      first.      The server must return a value for each attribute that the client      requests if the attribute is supported by the server.  If the      server does not support an attribute or cannot approximate a      useful value then it must not return the attribute value and must      not set the attribute bit in the result bitmap.  The server must      return an error if it supports an attribute but cannot obtain its      value.  In that case no attribute values will be returned.      All servers must support the mandatory attributes as specified in      the section "File Attributes".      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   ERRORS         NFS4ERR_ACCES         NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE         NFS4ERR_DELAY         NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED         NFS4ERR_INVAL         NFS4ERR_IO         NFS4ERR_MOVED         NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE         NFS4ERR_RESOURCE         NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 116]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000         NFS4ERR_STALE         NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.8.  Operation 10: GETFH - Get Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS         (cfh) -> filehandle   ARGUMENT         /* CURRENT_FH: */         void;   RESULT         struct GETFH4resok {                 nfs_fh4         object;         };         union GETFH4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {          case NFS4_OK:                 GETFH4resok     resok4;          default:                 void;         };   DESCRIPTION         This operation returns the current filehandle value.         On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      Operations that change the current filehandle like LOOKUP or      CREATE do not automatically return the new filehandle as a result.      For instance, if a client needs to lookup a directory entry and      obtain its filehandle then the following request is needed.               PUTFH  (directory filehandle)               LOOKUP (entry name)               GETFH   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIREDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 117]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.9.  Operation 11: LINK - Create Link to a File   SYNOPSIS      (sfh), (cfh), newname -> (cfh), change_info   ARGUMENT      struct LINK4args {              /* SAVED_FH: source object */              /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */              component4      newname;      };   RESULT      struct LINK4resok {              change_info4    cinfo;      };      union LINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               LINK4resok resok4;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The LINK operation creates an additional newname for the file      represented by the saved filehandle, as set by the SAVEFH      operation, in the directory represented by the current filehandle.      The existing file and the target directory must reside within the      same file system on the server.  On success, the current      filehandle will continue to be the target directory.      For the target directory, the server returns change_info4      information in cinfo.  With the atomic field of the change_info4      struct, the server will indicate if the before and after change      attributes were obtained atomically with respect to the link      creation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 118]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      If the newname has a length of 0 (zero), or if newname does not      obey the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be      returned.   IMPLEMENTATION      Changes to any property of the "hard" linked files are reflected      in all of the linked files.  When a link is made to a file, the      attributes for the file should have a value for numlinks that is      one greater than the value before the LINK operation.      The comments under RENAME regarding object and target residing on      the same file system apply here as well. The comments regarding      the target name applies as well.      Note that symbolic links are created with the CREATE operation.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE NFS4ERR_DELAY NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED NFS4ERR_INVAL NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR NFS4ERR_MLINK NFS4ERR_MOVED NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE NFS4ERR_NOSPC NFS4ERR_NOTDIR NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE NFS4ERR_ROFS NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC NFS4ERR_XDEV14.2.10.  Operation 12: LOCK - Create Lock   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) type, seqid, reclaim, stateid, offset, length -> stateid,      access   ARGUMENT      enum nfs4_lock_type {              READ_LT         = 1,              WRITE_LT        = 2,              READW_LT        = 3,    /* blocking read */              WRITEW_LT       = 4     /* blocking write */ };      struct LOCK4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: file */              nfs_lock_type4  locktype;              seqid4          seqid;              bool            reclaim;              stateid4        stateid;              offset4         offset;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 119]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000              length4         length; };   RESULT      struct LOCK4denied {              nfs_lockowner4  owner;              offset4         offset;              length4         length; };      union LOCK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               stateid4       stateid;       case NFS4ERR_DENIED:               LOCK4denied    denied;       default:               void; };   DESCRIPTION      The LOCK operation requests a record lock for the byte range      specified by the offset and length parameters.  The lock type is      also specified to be one of the nfs4_lock_types.  If this is a      reclaim request, the reclaim parameter will be TRUE;      Bytes in a file may be locked even if those bytes are not      currently allocated to the file.  To lock the file from a specific      offset through the end-of-file (no matter how long the file      actually is) use a length field with all bits set to 1 (one).  To      lock the entire file, use an offset of 0 (zero) and a length with      all bits set to 1.  A length of 0 is reserved and should not be      used.      In the case that the lock is denied, the owner, offset, and length      of a conflicting lock are returned.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      If the server is unable to determine the exact offset and length      of the conflicting lock, the same offset and length that were      provided in the arguments should be returned in the denied      results.  The File Locking section contains a full description of      this and the other file locking operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 120]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID NFS4ERR_DELAY NFS4ERR_DENIED NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED NFS4ERR_GRACE NFS4ERR_INVAL NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT NFS4ERR_STALE NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.11.  Operation 13: LOCKT - Test For Lock   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) type, owner, offset, length -> {void, NFS4ERR_DENIED ->      owner}   ARGUMENT      struct LOCKT4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: file */              nfs_lock_type4  locktype;              nfs_lockowner4  owner;              offset4         offset;              length4         length; };   RESULT      union LOCKT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4ERR_DENIED:               LOCK4denied    denied;       case NFS4_OK:               void;       default:               void; };   DESCRIPTION      The LOCKT operation tests the lock as specified in the arguments.      If a conflicting lock exists, the owner, offset, and length of the      conflicting lock are returned; if no lock is held, nothing other      than NFS4_OK is returned.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      If the server is unable to determine the exact offset and length      of the conflicting lock, the same offset and length that were      provided in the arguments should be returned in the deniedShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 121]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      results.  The File Locking section contains further discussion of      the file locking mechanisms.      LOCKT uses nfs_lockowner4 instead of a stateid4, as LOCK does, to      identify the owner so that the client does not have to open the      file to test for the existence of a lock.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.12.  Operation 14: LOCKU - Unlock File   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) type, seqid, stateid, offset, length -> stateid   ARGUMENT      struct LOCKU4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: file */              nfs_lock_type4  locktype;              seqid4          seqid;              stateid4        stateid;              offset4         offset;              length4         length;      };   RESULT      union LOCKU4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case   NFS4_OK:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 122]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000               stateid4       stateid;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The LOCKU operation unlocks the record lock specified by the      parameters.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      The File Locking section contains a full description of this and      the other file locking procedures.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.13.  Operation 15: LOOKUP - Lookup Filename   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), filenames -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      struct LOOKUP4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 123]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000              pathname4       path;      };   RESULT      struct LOOKUP4res {              /* CURRENT_FH: object */              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      This operation LOOKUPs or finds a file system object starting from      the directory specified by the current filehandle.  LOOKUP      evaluates the pathname contained in the array of names and obtains      a new current filehandle from the final name.  All but the final      name in the list must be the names of directories.      If the pathname cannot be evaluated either because a component      does not exist or because the client does not have permission to      evaluate a component of the path, then an error will be returned      and the current filehandle will be unchanged.      If the path is a zero length array, if any component does not obey      the UTF-8 definition, or if any component in the path is of zero      length, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION      If the client prefers a partial evaluation of the path then a      sequence of LOOKUP operations can be substituted e.g.               PUTFH  (directory filehandle)               LOOKUP "pub" "foo" "bar"               GETFH      or, if the client wishes to obtain the intermediate filehandles               PUTFH  (directory filehandle)               LOOKUP "pub"               GETFH               LOOKUP "foo"               GETFH               LOOKUP "bar"               GETFHShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 124]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS version 4 servers depart from the semantics of previous NFS      versions in allowing LOOKUP requests to cross mountpoints on the      server.  The client can detect a mountpoint crossing by comparing      the fsid attribute of the directory with the fsid attribute of the      directory looked up.  If the fsids are different then the new      directory is a server mountpoint.  Unix clients that detect a      mountpoint crossing will need to mount the server's filesystem.      This needs to be done to maintain the file object identity      checking mechanisms common to Unix clients.      Servers that limit NFS access to "shares" or "exported"      filesystems should provide a pseudo-filesystem into which the      exported filesystems can be integrated, so that clients can browse      the server's name space.  The clients view of a pseudo filesystem      will be limited to paths that lead to exported filesystems.      Note: previous versions of the protocol assigned special semantics      to the names "." and "..".  NFS version 4 assigns no special      semantics to these names.  The LOOKUPP operator must be used to      lookup a parent directory.      Note that this procedure does not follow symbolic links.  The      client is responsible for all parsing of filenames including      filenames that are modified by symbolic links encountered during      the lookup process.      If the current file handle supplied is not a directory but a      symbolic link, the error NFS4ERR_SYMLINK is returned as the error.      For all other non-directory file types, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      is returned.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_SYMLINK      NFS4ERR_WRONGSECShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 125]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.14.  Operation 16: LOOKUPP - Lookup Parent Directory   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      /* CURRENT_FH: object */      void;   RESULT      struct LOOKUPP4res {              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      The current filehandle is assumed to refer to a regular directory      or a named attribute directory.  LOOKUPP assigns the filehandle      for its parent directory to be the current filehandle.  If there      is no parent directory an NFS4ERR_ENOENT error must be returned.      Therefore, NFS4ERR_ENOENT will be returned by the server when the      current filehandle is at the root or top of the server's file      tree.   IMPLEMENTATION      As for LOOKUP, LOOKUPP will also cross mountpoints.      If the current filehandle is not a directory or named attribute      directory, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR is returned.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 126]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.15.  Operation 17: NVERIFY - Verify Difference in Attributes   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), fattr -> -   ARGUMENT      struct NVERIFY4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: object */              fattr4          obj_attributes;      };   RESULT      struct NVERIFY4res {              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      This operation is used to prefix a sequence of operations to be      performed if one or more attributes have changed on some      filesystem object.  If all the attributes match then the error      NFS4ERR_SAME must be returned.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      This operation is useful as a cache validation operator.  If the      object to which the attributes belong has changed then the      following operations may obtain new data associated with that      object.  For instance, to check if a file has been changed and      obtain new data if it has:               PUTFH  (public)               LOOKUP "pub" "foo" "bar"               NVERIFY attrbits attrs               READ 0 32767      In the case that a recommended attribute is specified in the      NVERIFY operation and the server does not support that attribute      for the file system object, the error NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP is returned      to the client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 127]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SAME      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.16.  Operation 18: OPEN - Open a Regular File   SYNOPSIS  (cfh), claim, openhow, owner, seqid, access, deny -> (cfh),  stateid, cinfo, rflags, open_confirm, delegation   ARGUMENT  struct OPEN4args {          open_claim4     claim;          openflag4       openhow;          nfs_lockowner4  owner;          seqid4          seqid;          uint32_t        share_access;          uint32_t        share_deny;  };  enum createmode4 {          UNCHECKED4      = 0,          GUARDED4        = 1,          EXCLUSIVE4      = 2  };  union createhow4 switch (createmode4 mode) {   case UNCHECKED4:   case GUARDED4:           fattr4         createattrs;   case EXCLUSIVE4:           verifier4      createverf;  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 128]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000  enum opentype4 {          OPEN4_NOCREATE  = 0,          OPEN4_CREATE    = 1  };  union openflag4 switch (opentype4 opentype) {   case OPEN4_CREATE:           createhow4     how;   default:           void;  };  /* Next definitions used for OPEN delegation */  enum limit_by4 {          NFS_LIMIT_SIZE          = 1,          NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS        = 2          /* others as needed */  };  struct nfs_modified_limit4 {          uint32_t        num_blocks;          uint32_t        bytes_per_block;  };  union nfs_space_limit4 switch (limit_by4 limitby) {   /* limit specified as file size */   case NFS_LIMIT_SIZE:           uint64_t               filesize;   /* limit specified by number of blocks */   case NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS:           nfs_modified_limit4    mod_blocks;  } ;  enum open_delegation_type4 {          OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE      = 0,          OPEN_DELEGATE_READ      = 1,          OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE     = 2  };  enum open_claim_type4 {          CLAIM_NULL              = 0,          CLAIM_PREVIOUS          = 1,          CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR      = 2,          CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV     = 3  };  struct open_claim_delegate_cur4 {          pathname4       file;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 129]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000          stateid4        delegate_stateid;  };  union open_claim4 switch (open_claim_type4 claim) {   /*    * No special rights to file. Ordinary OPEN of the specified file.    */   case CLAIM_NULL:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           pathname4      file;   /*    * Right to the file established by an open previous to server    * reboot.  File identified by filehandle obtained at that time    * rather than by name.    */   case CLAIM_PREVIOUS:           /* CURRENT_FH: file being reclaimed */           uint32_t        delegate_type;   /*    * Right to file based on a delegation granted by the server.    * File is specified by name.    */   case CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           open_claim_delegate_cur4       delegate_cur_info;   /* Right to file based on a delegation granted to a previous boot    * instance of the client.  File is specified by name.    */   case CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           pathname4      file_delegate_prev;  };   RESULT  struct open_read_delegation4 {          stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/          bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                             delegations obtained                                             by reclaim                                             (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */          nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                             need an ACCESS call to                                             open for read */  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 130]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000  struct open_write_delegation4 {          stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/          bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                             delegations obtained                                             by reclaim                                             (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */          nfs_space_limit4 space_limit;   /* Defines condition that                                             the client must check to                                             determine whether the                                             file needs to be flushed                                             to the server on close.                                             */          nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                             need an ACCESS call as                                             part of a delegated                                             open. */  };  union open_delegation4  switch (open_delegation_type4 delegation_type) {          case OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE:                  void;          case OPEN_DELEGATE_READ:                  open_read_delegation4 read;          case OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE:                  open_write_delegation4 write;  };  const OPEN4_RESULT_MLOCK        = 0x00000001;  const OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM= 0x00000002;  struct OPEN4resok {          stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for open */          change_info4    cinfo;          /* Directory Change Info */          uint32_t        rflags;         /* Result flags */          verifier4       open_confirm;   /* OPEN_CONFIRM verifier */          open_delegation4 delegation;    /* Info on any open                                             delegation */  };  union OPEN4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {   case NFS4_OK:          /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */          OPEN4resok      resok4;   default:          void;  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 131]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   WARNING TO CLIENT IMPLEMENTORS      OPEN resembles LOOKUP in that it generates a filehandle for the      client to use.  Unlike LOOKUP though, OPEN creates server state on      the filehandle.  In normal circumstances, the client can only      release this state with a CLOSE operation.  CLOSE uses the current      filehandle to determine which file to close.  Therefore the client      MUST follow every OPEN operation with a GETFH operation in the      same COMPOUND procedure.  This will supply the client with the      filehandle such that CLOSE can be used appropriately.      Simply waiting for the lease on the file to expire is insufficient      because the server may maintain the state indefinitely as long as      another client does not attempt to make a conflicting access to      the same file.   DESCRIPTION      The OPEN operation creates and/or opens a regular file in a      directory with the provided name.  If the file does not exist at      the server and creation is desired, specification of the method of      creation is provided by the openhow parameter.  The client has the      choice of three creation methods: UNCHECKED, GUARDED, or      EXCLUSIVE.      UNCHECKED means that the file should be created if a file of that      name does not exist and encountering an existing regular file of      that name is not an error.  For this type of create, createattrs      specifies the initial set of attributes for the file.  The set of      attributes may includes any writable attribute valid for regular      files.  When an UNCHECKED create encounters an existing file, the      attributes specified by createattrs is not used, except that when      an object_size of zero is specified, the existing file is      truncated.  If GUARDED is specified, the server checks for the      presence of a duplicate object by name before performing the      create.  If a duplicate exists, an error of NFS4ERR_EXIST is      returned as the status.  If the object does not exist, the request      is performed as described for UNCHECKED.      EXCLUSIVE specifies that the server is to follow exclusive      creation semantics, using the verifier to ensure exclusive      creation of the target.  The server should check for the presence      of a duplicate object by name.  If the object does not exist, the      server creates the object and stores the verifier with the object.      If the object does exist and the stored verifier matches the      client provided verifier, the server uses the existing object as      the newly created object.  If the stored verifier does not match,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 132]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      then an error of NFS4ERR_EXIST is returned.  No attributes may be      provided in this case, since the server may use an attribute of      the target object to store the verifier.      For the target directory, the server returns change_info4      information in cinfo.  With the atomic field of the change_info4      struct, the server will indicate if the before and after change      attributes were obtained atomically with respect to the link      creation.      Upon successful creation, the current filehandle is replaced by      that of the new object.      The OPEN procedure provides for DOS SHARE capability with the use      of the access and deny fields of the OPEN arguments.  The client      specifies at OPEN the required access and deny modes.  For clients      that do not directly support SHAREs (i.e. Unix), the expected deny      value is DENY_NONE.  In the case that there is a existing SHARE      reservation that conflicts with the OPEN request, the server      returns the error NFS4ERR_DENIED.  For a complete SHARE request,      the client must provide values for the owner and seqid fields for      the OPEN argument.  For additional discussion of SHARE semantics      see the section on 'Share Reservations'.      In the case that the client is recovering state from a server      failure, the reclaim field of the OPEN argument is used to signify      that the request is meant to reclaim state previously held.      The "claim" field of the OPEN argument is used to specify the file      to be opened and the state information which the client claims to      possess.  There are four basic claim types which cover the various      situations for an OPEN.  They are as follows:      CLAIM_NULL                            For the client, this is a new OPEN                            request and there is no previous state                            associate with the file for the client.      CLAIM_PREVIOUS                            The client is claiming basic OPEN state                            for a file that was held previous to a                            server reboot.  Generally used when a                            server is returning persistent file                            handles; the client may not have the                            file name to reclaim the OPEN.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 133]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR                            The client is claiming a delegation for                            OPEN as granted by the server.                            Generally this is done as part of                            recalling a delegation.      CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV                            The client is claiming a delegation                            granted to a previous client instance;                            used after the client reboots.      For OPEN requests whose claim type is other than CLAIM_PREVIOUS      (i.e. requests other than those devoted to reclaiming opens after      a server reboot) that reach the server during its grace or lease      expiration period, the server returns an error of NFS4ERR_GRACE.      For any OPEN request, the server may return an open delegation,      which allows further opens and closes to be handled locally on the      client as described in the section Open Delegation.  Note that      delegation is up to the server to decide.  The client should never      assume that delegation will or will not be granted in a particular      instance.  It should always be prepared for either case.  A      partial exception is the reclaim (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) case, in which a      delegation type is claimed.  In this case, delegation will always      be granted, although the server may specify an immediate recall in      the delegation structure.      The rflags returned by a successful OPEN allow the server to      return information governing how the open file is to be handled.      OPEN4_RESULT_MLOCK indicates to the caller that mandatory locking      is in effect for this file and the client should act appropriately      with regard to data cached on the client.  OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM      indicates that the client MUST execute an OPEN_CONFIRM operation      before using the open file.      If the file is a zero length array, if any component does not obey      the UTF-8 definition, or if any component in the path is of zero      length, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.      When an OPEN is done and the specified lockowner already has the      resulting filehandle open, the result is to "OR" together the new      share and deny status together with the existing status.  In this      case, only a single CLOSE need be done, even though multiple      OPEN's were completed.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 134]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   IMPLEMENTATION      The OPEN procedure contains support for EXCLUSIVE create.  The      mechanism is similar to the support in NFS version 3 [RFC1813].      As in NFS version 3, this mechanism provides reliable exclusive      creation.  Exclusive create is invoked when the how parameter is      EXCLUSIVE.  In this case, the client provides a verifier that can      reasonably be expected to be unique.  A combination of a client      identifier, perhaps the client network address, and a unique      number generated by the client, perhaps the RPC transaction      identifier, may be appropriate.      If the object does not exist, the server creates the object and      stores the verifier in stable storage. For file systems that do      not provide a mechanism for the storage of arbitrary file      attributes, the server may use one or more elements of the object      meta-data to store the verifier. The verifier must be stored in      stable storage to prevent erroneous failure on retransmission of      the request. It is assumed that an exclusive create is being      performed because exclusive semantics are critical to the      application. Because of the expected usage, exclusive CREATE does      not rely solely on the normally volatile duplicate request cache      for storage of the verifier. The duplicate request cache in      volatile storage does not survive a crash and may actually flush      on a long network partition, opening failure windows.  In the UNIX      local file system environment, the expected storage location for      the verifier on creation is the meta-data (time stamps) of the      object. For this reason, an exclusive object create may not      include initial attributes because the server would have nowhere      to store the verifier.      If the server can not support these exclusive create semantics,      possibly because of the requirement to commit the verifier to      stable storage, it should fail the OPEN request with the error,      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP.      During an exclusive CREATE request, if the object already exists,      the server reconstructs the object's verifier and compares it with      the verifier in the request. If they match, the server treats the      request as a success. The request is presumed to be a duplicate of      an earlier, successful request for which the reply was lost and      that the server duplicate request cache mechanism did not detect.      If the verifiers do not match, the request is rejected with the      status, NFS4ERR_EXIST.      Once the client has performed a successful exclusive create, it      must issue a SETATTR to set the correct object attributes.  Until      it does so, it should not rely upon any of the object attributes,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 135]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      since the server implementation may need to overload object meta-      data to store the verifier.  The subsequent SETATTR must not occur      in the same COMPOUND request as the OPEN.  This separation will      guarantee that the exclusive create mechanism will continue to      function properly in the face of retransmission of the request.      Use of the GUARDED attribute does not provide exactly-once      semantics.  In particular, if a reply is lost and the server does      not detect the retransmission of the request, the procedure can      fail with NFS4ERR_EXIST, even though the create was performed      successfully.      For SHARE reservations, the client must specify a value for access      that is one of READ, WRITE, or BOTH.  For deny, the client must      specify one of NONE, READ, WRITE, or BOTH.  If the client fails to      do this, the server must return NFS4ERR_INVAL.      If the final component provided to OPEN is a symbolic link, the      error NFS4ERR_SYMLINK will be returned to the client.  If an      intermediate component of the pathname provided to OPEN is a      symbolic link, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR will be returned to the      client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_SYMLINKShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 136]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.17.  Operation 19: OPENATTR - Open Named Attribute Directory   SYNOPSIS   (cfh) -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT   /* CURRENT_FH: file or directory */   void;   RESULT   struct OPENATTR4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: name attr directory*/           nfsstat4        status;   };   DESCRIPTION      The OPENATTR operation is used to obtain the filehandle of the      named attribute directory associated with the current filehandle.      The result of the OPENATTR will be a filehandle to an object of      type NF4ATTRDIR.  From this filehandle, READDIR and LOOKUP      procedures can be used to obtain filehandles for the various named      attributes associated with the original file system object.      Filehandles returned within the named attribute directory will      have a type of NF4NAMEDATTR.   IMPLEMENTATION      If the server does not support named attributes for the current      filehandle, an error of NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP will be returned to the      client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 137]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.18.  Operation 20: OPEN_CONFIRM - Confirm Open   SYNOPSIS   (cfh), seqid, open_confirm-> stateid   ARGUMENT   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           seqid4          seqid;           verifier4       open_confirm;   /* OPEN_CONFIRM verifier */   };   RESULT   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4resok {           stateid4        stateid;   };   union OPEN_CONFIRM4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            OPEN_CONFIRM4resok     resok4;    default:            void;   };   DESCRIPTION      This operation is used to confirm the sequence id usage for the      first time that a nfs_lockowner is used by a client.  The OPEN      operation returns a opaque confirmation verifier that is then      passed to this operation along with the next sequence id for the      nfs_lockowner.  The sequence id passed to the OPEN_CONFIRM must be      1 (one) greater than the seqid passed to the OPEN operation from      which the open_confirm value was obtained.  If the server receives      an unexpected sequence id with respect to the original open, then      the server assumes that the client will not confirm the original      OPEN and all state associated with the original OPEN is released      by the server.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 138]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   IMPLEMENTATION      A given client might generate many nfs_lockowner data structures      for a given clientid.  The client will periodically either dispose      of its nfs_lockowners or stop using them for indefinite periods of      time.  The latter situation is why the NFS version 4 protocol does      not have a an explicit operation to exit an nfs_lockowner: such an      operation is of no use in that situation.  Instead, to avoid      unbounded memory use, the server needs to implement a strategy for      disposing of nfs_lockowners that have no current lock, open, or      delegation state for any files and have not been used recently.      The time period used to determine when to dispose of      nfs_lockowners is an implementation choice.  The time period      should certainly be no less than the lease time plus any grace      period the server wishes to implement beyond a lease time.  The      OPEN_CONFIRM operation allows the server to safely dispose of      unused nfs_lockowner data structures.      In the case that a client issues an OPEN operation and the server      no longer has a record of the nfs_lockowner, the server needs      ensure that this is a new OPEN and not a replay or retransmission.      A lazy server implementation might require confirmation for every      nfs_lockowner for which it has no record.  However, this is not      necessary until the server records the fact that it has disposed      of one nfs_lockowner for the given clientid.      The server must hold unconfirmed OPEN state until one of three      events occur.  First, the client sends an OPEN_CONFIRM request      with the appropriate sequence id and confirmation verifier within      the lease period.  In this case, the OPEN state on the server goes      to confirmed, and the nfs_lockowner on the server is fully      established.      Second, the client sends another OPEN request with a sequence id      that is incorrect for the nfs_lockowner (out of sequence).  In      this case, the server assumes the second OPEN request is valid and      the first one is a replay.  The server cancels the OPEN state of      the first OPEN request, establishes an unconfirmed OPEN state for      the second OPEN request, and responds to the second OPEN request      with an indication that an OPEN_CONFIRM is needed.  The process      then repeats itself.  While there is a potential for a denial of      service attack on the client, it is mitigated if the client and      server require the use of a security flavor based on Kerberos V5,      LIPKEY, or some other flavor that uses cryptography.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 139]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      What if the server is in the unconfirmed OPEN state for a given      nfs_lockowner, and it receives an operation on the nfs_lockowner      that has a stateid but the operation is not OPEN, or it is      OPEN_CONFIRM but with the wrong confirmation verifier?  Then, even      if the seqid is correct, the server returns NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID,      because the server assumes the operation is a replay: if the      server has no established OPEN state, then there is no way, for      example, a LOCK operation could be valid.      Third, neither of the two aforementioned events occur for the      nfs_lockowner within the lease period.  In this case, the OPEN      state is cancelled and disposal of the nfs_lockowner can occur.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.19.  Operation 21: OPEN_DOWNGRADE - Reduce Open File Access   SYNOPSIS   (cfh), stateid, seqid, access, deny -> stateid   ARGUMENT   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           stateid4        stateid;           seqid4          seqid;           uint32_t        share_access;           uint32_t        share_deny;   };   RESULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 140]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok {           stateid4        stateid;   };   union OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res switch(nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok    resok4;    default:           void;   };   This operation is used to adjust the access and deny bits for a given   open.  This is necessary when a given lockowner opens the same file   multiple times with different access and deny flags.  In this   situation, a close of one of the open's may change the appropriate   access and deny flags to remove bits associated with open's no longer   in effect.   The access and deny bits specified in this operation replace the   current ones for the specified open file.  If either the access or   the deny mode specified includes bits not in effect for the open, the   error NFS4ERR_INVAL should be returned.  Since access and deny bits   are subsets of those already granted, it is not possible for this   request to be denied because of conflicting share reservations.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED NFS4ERR_INVAL NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT NFS4ERR_STALE NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.20.  Operation 22: PUTFH - Set Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS      filehandle -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      struct PUTFH4args {              nfs4_fh         object; };   RESULT      struct PUTFH4res {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 141]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000              /* CURRENT_FH: */              nfsstat4        status; };   DESCRIPTION      Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle provided as an      argument.   IMPLEMENTATION      Commonly used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the      context for following operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.21.  Operation 23: PUTPUBFH - Set Public Filehandle   SYNOPSIS      - -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      void;   RESULT      struct PUTPUBFH4res {              /* CURRENT_FH: public fh */              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle that      represents the public filehandle of the server's name space.  This      filehandle may be different from the "root" filehandle which may      be associated with some other directory on the server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 142]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   IMPLEMENTATION      Used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the context      for following operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.22.  Operation 24: PUTROOTFH - Set Root Filehandle   SYNOPSIS      - -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      void;   RESULT      struct PUTROOTFH4res {              /* CURRENT_FH: root fh */              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle that      represents the root of the server's name space.  From this      filehandle a LOOKUP operation can locate any other filehandle on      the server. This filehandle may be different from the "public"      filehandle which may be associated with some other directory on      the server.   IMPLEMENTATION      Commonly used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the      context for following operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_WRONGSECShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 143]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.23.  Operation 25: READ - Read from File   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), offset, count, stateid -> eof, data   ARGUMENT      struct READ4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: file */              stateid4        stateid;              offset4         offset;              count4          count;      };   RESULT      struct READ4resok {              bool            eof;              opaque          data<>;      };      union READ4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               READ4resok     resok4;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The READ operation reads data from the regular file identified by      the current filehandle.      The client provides an offset of where the READ is to start and a      count of how many bytes are to be read.  An offset of 0 (zero)      means to read data starting at the beginning of the file.  If      offset is greater than or equal to the size of the file, the      status, NFS4_OK, is returned with a data length set to 0 (zero)      and eof is set to TRUE.  The READ is subject to access permissions      checking.      If the client specifies a count value of 0 (zero), the READ      succeeds and returns 0 (zero) bytes of data again subject to      access permissions checking.  The server may choose to return      fewer bytes than specified by the client.  The client needs to      check for this condition and handle the condition appropriately.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 144]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The stateid value for a READ request represents a value returned      from a previous record lock or share reservation request.  Used by      the server to verify that the associated lock is still valid and      to update lease timeouts for the client.      If the read ended at the end-of-file (formally, in a correctly      formed READ request, if offset + count is equal to the size of the      file), or the read request extends beyond the size of the file (if      offset + count is greater than the size of the file), eof is      returned as TRUE; otherwise it is FALSE.  A successful READ of an      empty file will always return eof as TRUE.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      It is possible for the server to return fewer than count bytes of      data.  If the server returns less than the count requested and eof      set to FALSE, the client should issue another READ to get the      remaining data.  A server may return less data than requested      under several circumstances.  The file may have been truncated by      another client or perhaps on the server itself, changing the file      size from what the requesting client believes to be the case.      This would reduce the actual amount of data available to the      client.  It is possible that the server may back off the transfer      size and reduce the read request return.  Server resource      exhaustion may also occur necessitating a smaller read return.      If the file is locked the server will return an NFS4ERR_LOCKED      error.  Since the lock may be of short duration, the client may      choose to retransmit the READ request (with exponential backoff)      until the operation succeeds.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_LOCKED      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVEDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 145]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NXIO      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.24.  Operation 26: READDIR - Read Directory   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), cookie, cookieverf, dircount, maxcount, attrbits ->      cookieverf { cookie, filename, attrbits, attributes }   ARGUMENT      struct READDIR4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              nfs_cookie4     cookie;              verifier4       cookieverf;              count4          dircount;              count4          maxcount;              bitmap4         attr_request;      };   RESULT      struct entry4 {              nfs_cookie4     cookie;              component4      name;              fattr4          attrs;              entry4          *nextentry;      };      struct dirlist4 {              entry4          *entries;              bool            eof;      };      struct READDIR4resok {              verifier4       cookieverf;              dirlist4        reply;      };      union READDIR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 146]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000       case NFS4_OK:               READDIR4resok  resok4;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The READDIR operation retrieves a variable number of entries from      a file system directory and returns client requested attributes      for each entry along with information to allow the client to      request additional directory entries in a subsequent READDIR.      The arguments contain a cookie value that represents where the      READDIR should start within the directory.  A value of 0 (zero)      for the cookie is used to start reading at the beginning of the      directory.  For subsequent READDIR requests, the client specifies      a cookie value that is provided by the server on a previous      READDIR request.      The cookieverf value should be set to 0 (zero) when the cookie      value is 0 (zero) (first directory read).  On subsequent requests,      it should be a cookieverf as returned by the server.  The      cookieverf must match that returned by the READDIR in which the      cookie was acquired.      The dircount portion of the argument is a hint of the maximum      number of bytes of directory information that should be returned.      This value represents the length of the names of the directory      entries and the cookie value for these entries.  This length      represents the XDR encoding of the data (names and cookies) and      not the length in the native format of the server.  The server may      return less data.      The maxcount value of the argument is the maximum number of bytes      for the result.  This maximum size represents all of the data      being returned and includes the XDR overhead.  The server may      return less data.  If the server is unable to return a single      directory entry within the maxcount limit, the error      NFS4ERR_READDIR_NOSPC will be returned to the client.      Finally, attrbits represents the list of attributes to be returned      for each directory entry supplied by the server.      On successful return, the server's response will provide a list of      directory entries.  Each of these entries contains the name of the      directory entry, a cookie value for that entry, and the associated      attributes as requested.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 147]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The cookie value is only meaningful to the server and is used as a      "bookmark" for the directory entry.  As mentioned, this cookie is      used by the client for subsequent READDIR operations so that it      may continue reading a directory.  The cookie is similar in      concept to a READ offset but should not be interpreted as such by      the client.  Ideally, the cookie value should not change if the      directory is modified since the client may be caching these      values.      In some cases, the server may encounter an error while obtaining      the attributes for a directory entry.  Instead of returning an      error for the entire READDIR operation, the server can instead      return the attribute 'fattr4_rdattr_error'.  With this, the server      is able to communicate the failure to the client and not fail the      entire operation in the instance of what might be a transient      failure.  Obviously, the client must request the      fattr4_rdattr_error attribute for this method to work properly.      If the client does not request the attribute, the server has no      choice but to return failure for the entire READDIR operation.      For some file system environments, the directory entries "." and      ".."  have special meaning and in other environments, they may      not.  If the server supports these special entries within a      directory, they should not be returned to the client as part of      the READDIR response.  To enable some client environments, the      cookie values of 0, 1, and 2 are to be considered reserved.  Note      that the Unix client will use these values when combining the      server's response and local representations to enable a fully      formed Unix directory presentation to the application.      For READDIR arguments, cookie values of 1 and 2 should not be used      and for READDIR results cookie values of 0, 1, and 2 should not      returned.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      The server's file system directory representations can differ      greatly.  A client's programming interfaces may also be bound to      the local operating environment in a way that does not translate      well into the NFS protocol.  Therefore the use of the dircount and      maxcount fields are provided to allow the client the ability to      provide guidelines to the server.  If the client is aggressive      about attribute collection during a READDIR, the server has an      idea of how to limit the encoded response.  The dircount field      provides a hint on the number of entries based solely on the names      of the directory entries.  Since it is a hint, it may be possibleShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 148]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      that a dircount value is zero.  In this case, the server is free      to ignore the dircount value and return directory information      based on the specified maxcount value.      The cookieverf may be used by the server to help manage cookie      values that may become stale.  It should be a rare occurrence that      a server is unable to continue properly reading a directory with      the provided cookie/cookieverf pair.  The server should make every      effort to avoid this condition since the application at the client      may not be able to properly handle this type of failure.      The use of the cookieverf will also protect the client from using      READDIR cookie values that may be stale.  For example, if the file      system has been migrated, the server may or may not be able to use      the same cookie values to service READDIR as the previous server      used.  With the client providing the cookieverf, the server is      able to provide the appropriate response to the client.  This      prevents the case where the server may accept a cookie value but      the underlying directory has changed and the response is invalid      from the client's context of its previous READDIR.      Since some servers will not be returning "." and ".." entries as      has been done with previous versions of the NFS protocol, the      client that requires these entries be present in READDIR responses      must fabricate them.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_READDIR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL      NFS4ERR_WRONGSECShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 149]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200014.2.25.  Operation 27: READLINK - Read Symbolic Link   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) -> linktext   ARGUMENT      /* CURRENT_FH: symlink */      void;   RESULT      struct READLINK4resok {              linktext4       link;      };      union READLINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               READLINK4resok resok4;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      READLINK reads the data associated with a symbolic link.  The data      is a UTF-8 string that is opaque to the server.  That is, whether      created by an NFS client or created locally on the server, the      data in a symbolic link is not interpreted when created, but is      simply stored.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      A symbolic link is nominally a pointer to another file.  The data      is not necessarily interpreted by the server, just stored in the      file.  It is possible for a client implementation to store a path      name that is not meaningful to the server operating system in a      symbolic link.  A READLINK operation returns the data to the      client for interpretation. If different implementations want to      share access to symbolic links, then they must agree on the      interpretation of the data in the symbolic link.      The READLINK operation is only allowed on objects of type NF4LNK.      The server should return the error, NFS4ERR_INVAL, if the object      is not of type, NF4LNK.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 150]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.26.  Operation 28: REMOVE - Remove Filesystem Object   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), filename -> change_info   ARGUMENT      struct REMOVE4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              component4       target;      };   RESULT      struct REMOVE4resok {              change_info4    cinfo;      }      union REMOVE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               REMOVE4resok   resok4;       default:               void;      }   DESCRIPTION      The REMOVE operation removes (deletes) a directory entry named by      filename from the directory corresponding to the current      filehandle.  If the entry in the directory was the last referenceShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 151]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      to the corresponding file system object, the object may be      destroyed.      For the directory where the filename was removed, the server      returns change_info4 information in cinfo.  With the atomic field      of the change_info4 struct, the server will indicate if the before      and after change attributes were obtained atomically with respect      to the removal.      If the target has a length of 0 (zero), or if target does not obey      the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      NFS versions 2 and 3 required a different operator RMDIR for      directory removal.  NFS version 4 REMOVE can be used to delete any      directory entry independent of its file type.      The concept of last reference is server specific. However, if the      numlinks field in the previous attributes of the object had the      value 1, the client should not rely on referring to the object via      a file handle. Likewise, the client should not rely on the      resources (disk space, directory entry, and so on) formerly      associated with the object becoming immediately available. Thus,      if a client needs to be able to continue to access a file after      using REMOVE to remove it, the client should take steps to make      sure that the file will still be accessible. The usual mechanism      used is to RENAME the file from its old name to a new hidden name.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 152]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.27.  Operation 29: RENAME - Rename Directory Entry   SYNOPSIS      (sfh), oldname (cfh), newname -> source_change_info,      target_change_info      ARGUMENT      struct RENAME4args {              /* SAVED_FH: source directory */              component4      oldname;              /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */              component4      newname;      };   RESULT      struct RENAME4resok {              change_info4    source_cinfo;              change_info4    target_cinfo;      };      union RENAME4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               RENAME4resok   resok4;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The RENAME operation renames the object identified by oldname in      the source directory corresponding to the saved filehandle, as set      by the SAVEFH operation, to newname in the target directory      corresponding to the current filehandle.  The operation is      required to be atomic to the client.  Source and target      directories must reside on the same file system on the server.  On      success, the current filehandle will continue to be the target      directory.      If the target directory already contains an entry with the name,      newname, the source object must be compatible with the target:      either both are non-directories or both are directories and the      target must be empty.  If compatible, the existing target isShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 153]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      removed before the rename occurs.  If they are not compatible or      if the target is a directory but not empty, the server will return      the error, NFS4ERR_EXIST.      If oldname and newname both refer to the same file (they might be      hard links of each other), then RENAME should perform no action      and return success.      For both directories involved in the RENAME, the server returns      change_info4 information.  With the atomic field of the      change_info4 struct, the server will indicate if the before and      after change attributes were obtained atomically with respect to      the rename.      If the oldname or newname has a length of 0 (zero), or if oldname      or newname does not obey the UTF-8 definition, the error      NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION      The RENAME operation must be atomic to the client.  The statement      "source and target directories must reside on the same file system      on the server" means that the fsid fields in the attributes for      the directories are the same. If they reside on different file      systems, the error, NFS4ERR_XDEV, is returned.      A filehandle may or may not become stale or expire on a rename.      However, server implementors are strongly encouraged to attempt to      keep file handles from becoming stale or expiring in this fashion.      On some servers, the filenames, "." and "..", are illegal as      either oldname or newname.  In addition, neither oldname nor      newname can be an alias for the source directory.  These servers      will return the error, NFS4ERR_INVAL, in these cases.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONGShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 154]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC      NFS4ERR_XDEV14.2.28.  Operation 30: RENEW - Renew a Lease   SYNOPSIS      stateid -> ()   ARGUMENT      struct RENEW4args {              stateid4        stateid;      };   RESULT      struct RENEW4res {              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      The RENEW operation is used by the client to renew leases which it      currently holds at a server.  In processing the RENEW request, the      server renews all leases associated with the client.  The      associated leases are determined by the client id provided via the      SETCLIENTID procedure.      The stateid for RENEW may not be one of the special stateids      consisting of all bits 0 (zero) or all bits 1.   IMPLEMENTATION   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_EXPIREDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 155]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.29.  Operation 31: RESTOREFH - Restore Saved Filehandle   SYNOPSIS      (sfh) -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT      /* SAVED_FH: */      void;   RESULT      struct RESTOREFH4res {              /* CURRENT_FH: value of saved fh */              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      Set the current filehandle to the value in the saved filehandle.      If there is no saved filehandle then return an error      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE.   IMPLEMENTATION      Operations like OPEN and LOOKUP use the current filehandle to      represent a directory and replace it with a new filehandle.      Assuming the previous filehandle was saved with a SAVEFH operator,      the previous filehandle can be restored as the current filehandle.      This is commonly used to obtain post-operation attributes for the      directory, e.g.               PUTFH (directory filehandle)               SAVEFH               GETATTR attrbits     (pre-op dir attrs)               CREATE optbits "foo" attrs               GETATTR attrbits     (file attributes)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 156]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000               RESTOREFH               GETATTR attrbits     (post-op dir attrs)   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.30.  Operation 32: SAVEFH - Save Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS      (cfh) -> (sfh)   ARGUMENT      /* CURRENT_FH: */      void;   RESULT      struct SAVEFH4res {              /* SAVED_FH: value of current fh */              nfsstat4        status;      };      DESCRIPTION      Save the current filehandle.  If a previous filehandle was saved      then it is no longer accessible.  The saved filehandle can be      restored as the current filehandle with the RESTOREFH operator.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 157]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.31.  Operation 33: SECINFO - Obtain Available Security   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), name -> { secinfo }   ARGUMENT      struct SECINFO4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: */              component4     name;      };   RESULT      enum rpc_gss_svc_t {              RPC_GSS_SVC_NONE        = 1,              RPC_GSS_SVC_INTEGRITY   = 2,              RPC_GSS_SVC_PRIVACY     = 3      };      struct rpcsec_gss_info {              sec_oid4        oid;              qop4            qop;              rpc_gss_svc_t   service;      };      struct secinfo4 {              uint32_t flavor;              opaque flavor_info<>;   /* null for AUTH_SYS, AUTH_NONE;                                         contains rpcsec_gss_info for                                         RPCSEC_GSS. */      };      typedef secinfo4 SECINFO4resok<>;      union SECINFO4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               SECINFO4resok resok4;       default:               void;      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 158]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   DESCRIPTION      The SECINFO operation is used by the client to obtain a list of      valid RPC authentication flavors for a specific file handle, file      name pair.  The result will contain an array which represents the      security mechanisms available.  The array entries are represented      by the secinfo4 structure.  The field 'flavor' will contain a      value of AUTH_NONE, AUTH_SYS (as defined in [RFC1831]), or      RPCSEC_GSS (as defined in [RFC2203]).      For the flavors, AUTH_NONE, and AUTH_SYS no additional security      information is returned.  For a return value of RPCSEC_GSS, a      security triple is returned that contains the mechanism object id      (as defined in [RFC2078]), the quality of protection (as defined      in [RFC2078]) and the service type (as defined in [RFC2203]).  It      is possible for SECINFO to return multiple entries with flavor      equal to RPCSEC_GSS with different security triple values.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      The SECINFO operation is expected to be used by the NFS client      when the error value of NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC is returned from another      NFS operation.  This signifies to the client that the server's      security policy is different from what the client is currently      using.  At this point, the client is expected to obtain a list of      possible security flavors and choose what best suits its policies.      It is recommended that the client issue the SECINFO call protected      by a security triple that uses either rpc_gss_svc_integrity or      rpc_gss_svc_privacy service. The use of rpc_gss_svc_none would      allow an attacker in the middle to modify the SECINFO results such      that the client might select a weaker algorithm in the set allowed      by server, making the client and/or server vulnerable to further      attacks.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 159]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.32.  Operation 34: SETATTR - Set Attributes   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), attrbits, attrvals -> -   ARGUMENT      struct SETATTR4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: target object */              stateid4        stateid;              fattr4          obj_attributes;      };   RESULT      struct SETATTR4res {              nfsstat4        status;              bitmap4         attrsset;      };   DESCRIPTION      The SETATTR operation changes one or more of the attributes of a      file system object.  The new attributes are specified with a      bitmap and the attributes that follow the bitmap in bit order.      The stateid is necessary for SETATTRs that change the size of a      file (modify the attribute object_size).  This stateid represents      a record lock, share reservation, or delegation which must be      valid for the SETATTR to modify the file data.  A valid stateid      would always be specified.  When the file size is not changed, the      special stateid consisting of all bits 0 (zero) should be used.      On either success or failure of the operation, the server will      return the attrsset bitmask to represent what (if any) attributes      were successfully set.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      The file size attribute is used to request changes to the size of      a file. A value of 0 (zero) causes the file to be truncated, a      value less than the current size of the file causes data from newShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 160]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      size to the end of the file to be discarded, and a size greater      than the current size of the file causes logically zeroed data      bytes to be added to the end of the file.  Servers are free to      implement this using holes or actual zero data bytes. Clients      should not make any assumptions regarding a server's      implementation of this feature, beyond that the bytes returned      will be zeroed.  Servers must support extending the file size via      SETATTR.      SETATTR is not guaranteed atomic.  A failed SETATTR may partially      change a file's attributes.      Changing the size of a file with SETATTR indirectly changes the      time_modify.  A client must account for this as size changes can      result in data deletion.      If server and client times differ, programs that compare client      time to file times can break. A time maintenance protocol should      be used to limit client/server time skew.      If the server cannot successfully set all the attributes it must      return an NFS4ERR_INVAL error.  If the server can only support 32      bit offsets and sizes, a SETATTR request to set the size of a file      to larger than can be represented in 32 bits will be rejected with      this same error.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FBIG      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_PERM      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFSShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 161]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.33.  Operation 35: SETCLIENTID - Negotiate Clientid   SYNOPSIS      client, callback -> clientid, setclientid_confirm   ARGUMENT      struct SETCLIENTID4args {              nfs_client_id4  client;              cb_client4      callback;      };   RESULT      struct SETCLIENTID4resok {              clientid4       clientid;              verifier4       setclientid_confirm;      };      union SETCLIENTID4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               SETCLIENTID4resok      resok4;       case NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE:               clientaddr4    client_using;       default:               void;      };   DESCRIPTION      The SETCLIENTID operation introduces the ability of the client to      notify the server of its intention to use a particular client      identifier and verifier pair.  Upon successful completion the      server will return a clientid which is used in subsequent file      locking requests and a confirmation verifier.  The client will use      the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation to return the verifier to the      server.  At that point, the client may use the clientid in      subsequent operations that require an nfs_lockowner.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 162]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The callback information provided in this operation will be used      if the client is provided an open delegation at a future point.      Therefore, the client must correctly reflect the program and port      numbers for the callback program at the time SETCLIENTID is used.   IMPLEMENTATION      The server takes the verifier and client identification supplied      in the nfs_client_id4 and searches for a match of the client      identification.  If no match is found the server saves the      principal/uid information along with the verifier and client      identification and returns a unique clientid that is used as a      shorthand reference to the supplied information.      If the server finds matching client identification and a      corresponding match in principal/uid, the server releases all      locking state for the client and returns a new clientid.      The principal, or principal to user-identifier mapping is taken      from the credential presented in the RPC.  As mentioned, the      server will use the credential and associated principal for the      matching with existing clientids.  If the client is a traditional      host-based client like a Unix NFS client, then the credential      presented may be the host credential.  If the client is a user      level client or lightweight client, the credential used may be the      end user's credential.  The client should take care in choosing an      appropriate credential since denial of service attacks could be      attempted by a rogue client that has access to the credential.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT14.2.34.  Operation 36: SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM - Confirm Clientid   SYNOPSIS      setclientid_confirm -> -   ARGUMENT      struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args {              verifier4       setclientid_confirm;      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 163]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   RESULT      struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res {              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      This operation is used by the client to confirm the results from a      previous call to SETCLIENTID.  The client provides the server      supplied (from a SETCLIENTID response) opaque confirmation      verifier.  The server responds with a simple status of success or      failure.   IMPLEMENTATION      The client must use the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation to confirm      its use of client identifier.  If the server is holding state for      a client which has presented a new verifier via SETCLIENTID, then      the state will not be released, as described in the section      "Client Failure and Recovery", until a valid SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM      is received.  Upon successful confirmation the server will release      the previous state held on behalf of the client.  The server      should choose a confirmation cookie value that is reasonably      unique for the client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.35.  Operation 37: VERIFY - Verify Same Attributes   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), fattr -> -   ARGUMENT      struct VERIFY4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: object */              fattr4          obj_attributes;      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 164]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   RESULT      struct VERIFY4res {              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      The VERIFY operation is used to verify that attributes have a      value assumed by the client before proceeding with following      operations in the compound request.  If any of the attributes do      not match then the error NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME must be returned.  The      current filehandle retains its value after successful completion      of the operation.   IMPLEMENTATION      One possible use of the VERIFY operation is the following compound      sequence.  With this the client is attempting to verify that the      file being removed will match what the client expects to be      removed.  This sequence can help prevent the unintended deletion      of a file.               PUTFH (directory filehandle)               LOOKUP (file name)               VERIFY (filehandle == fh)               PUTFH (directory filehandle)               REMOVE (file name)      This sequence does not prevent a second client from removing and      creating a new file in the middle of this sequence but it does      help avoid the unintended result.      In the case that a recommended attribute is specified in the      VERIFY operation and the server does not support that attribute      for the file system object, the error NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP is returned      to the client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPPShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 165]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.36.  Operation 38: WRITE - Write to File   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), offset, count, stability, stateid, data -> count, committed,      verifier   ARGUMENT      enum stable_how4 {              UNSTABLE4       = 0,              DATA_SYNC4      = 1,              FILE_SYNC4      = 2      };      struct WRITE4args {              /* CURRENT_FH: file */              stateid4        stateid;              offset4         offset;              stable_how4     stable;              opaque          data<>;      };   RESULT      struct WRITE4resok {              count4          count;              stable_how4     committed;              verifier4       writeverf;      };      union WRITE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               WRITE4resok    resok4;       default:               void;      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 166]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   DESCRIPTION      The WRITE operation is used to write data to a regular file.  The      target file is specified by the current filehandle.  The offset      specifies the offset where the data should be written.  An offset      of 0 (zero) specifies that the write should start at the beginning      of the file.  The count represents the number of bytes of data      that are to be written.  If the count is 0 (zero), the WRITE will      succeed and return a count of 0 (zero) subject to permissions      checking.  The server may choose to write fewer bytes than      requested by the client.      Part of the write request is a specification of how the write is      to be performed.  The client specifies with the stable parameter      the method of how the data is to be processed by the server.  If      stable is FILE_SYNC4, the server must commit the data written plus      all file system metadata to stable storage before returning      results.  This corresponds to the NFS version 2 protocol      semantics.  Any other behavior constitutes a protocol violation.      If stable is DATA_SYNC4, then the server must commit all of the      data to stable storage and enough of the metadata to retrieve the      data before returning.  The server implementor is free to      implement DATA_SYNC4 in the same fashion as FILE_SYNC4, but with a      possible performance drop.  If stable is UNSTABLE4, the server is      free to commit any part of the data and the metadata to stable      storage, including all or none, before returning a reply to the      client. There is no guarantee whether or when any uncommitted data      will subsequently be committed to stable storage. The only      guarantees made by the server are that it will not destroy any      data without changing the value of verf and that it will not      commit the data and metadata at a level less than that requested      by the client.      The stateid returned from a previous record lock or share      reservation request is provided as part of the argument.  The      stateid is used by the server to verify that the associated lock      is still valid and to update lease timeouts for the client.      Upon successful completion, the following results are returned.      The count result is the number of bytes of data written to the      file. The server may write fewer bytes than requested. If so, the      actual number of bytes written starting at location, offset, is      returned.      The server also returns an indication of the level of commitment      of the data and metadata via committed. If the server committed      all data and metadata to stable storage, committed should be set      to FILE_SYNC4. If the level of commitment was at least as strongShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 167]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      as DATA_SYNC4, then committed should be set to DATA_SYNC4.      Otherwise, committed must be returned as UNSTABLE4. If stable was      FILE4_SYNC, then committed must also be FILE_SYNC4: anything else      constitutes a protocol violation. If stable was DATA_SYNC4, then      committed may be FILE_SYNC4 or DATA_SYNC4: anything else      constitutes a protocol violation. If stable was UNSTABLE4, then      committed may be either FILE_SYNC4, DATA_SYNC4, or UNSTABLE4.      The final portion of the result is the write verifier, verf.  The      write verifier is a cookie that the client can use to determine      whether the server has changed state between a call to WRITE and a      subsequent call to either WRITE or COMMIT.  This cookie must be      consistent during a single instance of the NFS version 4 protocol      service and must be unique between instances of the NFS version 4      protocol server, where uncommitted data may be lost.      If a client writes data to the server with the stable argument set      to UNSTABLE4 and the reply yields a committed response of      DATA_SYNC4 or UNSTABLE4, the client will follow up some time in      the future with a COMMIT operation to synchronize outstanding      asynchronous data and metadata with the server's stable storage,      barring client error. It is possible that due to client crash or      other error that a subsequent COMMIT will not be received by the      server.      On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION      It is possible for the server to write fewer than count bytes of      data.  In this case, the server should not return an error unless      no data was written at all.  If the server writes less than count      bytes, the client should issue another WRITE to write the      remaining data.      It is assumed that the act of writing data to a file will cause      the time_modified of the file to be updated.  However, the      time_modified of the file should not be changed unless the      contents of the file are changed.  Thus, a WRITE request with      count set to 0 should not cause the time_modified of the file to      be updated.      The definition of stable storage has been historically a point of      contention.  The following expected properties of stable storage      may help in resolving design issues in the implementation. Stable      storage is persistent storage that survives:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 168]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000               1. Repeated power failures.               2. Hardware failures (of any board, power supply, etc.).               3. Repeated software crashes, including reboot cycle.      This definition does not address failure of the stable storage      module itself.      The verifier is defined to allow a client to detect different      instances of an NFS version 4 protocol server over which cached,      uncommitted data may be lost. In the most likely case, the      verifier allows the client to detect server reboots.  This      information is required so that the client can safely determine      whether the server could have lost cached data.  If the server      fails unexpectedly and the client has uncommitted data from      previous WRITE requests (done with the stable argument set to      UNSTABLE4 and in which the result committed was returned as      UNSTABLE4 as well) it may not have flushed cached data to stable      storage. The burden of recovery is on the client and the client      will need to retransmit the data to the server.      A suggested verifier would be to use the time that the server was      booted or the time the server was last started (if restarting the      server without a reboot results in lost buffers).      The committed field in the results allows the client to do more      effective caching.  If the server is committing all WRITE requests      to stable storage, then it should return with committed set to      FILE_SYNC4, regardless of the value of the stable field in the      arguments. A server that uses an NVRAM accelerator may choose to      implement this policy.  The client can use this to increase the      effectiveness of the cache by discarding cached data that has      already been committed on the server.      Some implementations may return NFS4ERR_NOSPC instead of      NFS4ERR_DQUOT when a user's quota is exceeded.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCES      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FBIG      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 169]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCKED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC15.  NFS Version 4 Callback Procedures   The procedures used for callbacks are defined in the following   sections.  In the interest of clarity, the terms "client" and   "server" refer to NFS clients and servers, despite the fact that for   an individual callback RPC, the sense of these terms would be   precisely the opposite.15.1.  Procedure 0: CB_NULL - No Operation   SYNOPSIS      <null>   ARGUMENT      void;   RESULT      void;   DESCRIPTION      Standard NULL procedure.  Void argument, void response.  Even      though there is no direct functionality associated with this      procedure, the server will use CB_NULL to confirm the existence of      a path for RPCs from server to client.   ERRORS      None.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 170]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200015.2.  Procedure 1: CB_COMPOUND - Compound Operations   SYNOPSIS      compoundargs -> compoundres   ARGUMENT      enum nfs_cb_opnum4 {              OP_CB_GETATTR           = 3,              OP_CB_RECALL            = 4 };      union nfs_cb_argop4 switch (unsigned argop) {       case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4args opcbgetattr;       case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4args  opcbrecall; };      struct CB_COMPOUND4args {              utf8string      tag;              uint32_t        minorversion;              nfs_cb_argop4   argarray<>; };   RESULT      union nfs_cb_resop4 switch (unsigned resop){       case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4res  opcbgetattr;       case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4res   opcbrecall; };      struct CB_COMPOUND4res {              nfsstat4 status;              utf8string      tag;              nfs_cb_resop4   resarray<>; };   DESCRIPTION      The CB_COMPOUND procedure is used to combine one or more of the      callback procedures into a single RPC request.  The main callback      RPC program has two main procedures: CB_NULL and CB_COMPOUND.  All      other operations use the CB_COMPOUND procedure as a wrapper.      In the processing of the CB_COMPOUND procedure, the client may      find that it does not have the available resources to execute any      or all of the operations within the CB_COMPOUND sequence.  In this      case, the error NFS4ERR_RESOURCE will be returned for the      particular operation within the CB_COMPOUND procedure where the      resource exhaustion occurred.  This assumes that all previous      operations within the CB_COMPOUND sequence have been evaluated      successfully.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 171]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      Contained within the CB_COMPOUND results is a 'status' field.      This status must be equivalent to the status of the last operation      that was executed within the CB_COMPOUND procedure.  Therefore, if      an operation incurred an error then the 'status' value will be the      same error value as is being returned for the operation that      failed.   IMPLEMENTATION      The CB_COMPOUND procedure is used to combine individual operations      into a single RPC request.  The client interprets each of the      operations in turn.  If an operation is executed by the client and      the status of that operation is NFS4_OK, then the next operation      in the CB_COMPOUND procedure is executed.  The client continues      this process until there are no more operations to be executed or      one of the operations has a status value other than NFS4_OK.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE15.2.1.  Operation 3: CB_GETATTR - Get Attributes   SYNOPSIS      fh, attrbits -> attrbits, attrvals   ARGUMENT      struct CB_GETATTR4args {              nfs_fh4 fh;              bitmap4 attr_request;      };   RESULT      struct CB_GETATTR4resok {              fattr4  obj_attributes;      };      union CB_GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               CB_GETATTR4resok       resok4;       default:               void;      };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 172]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   DESCRIPTION      The CB_GETATTR operation is used to obtain the attributes modified      by an open delegate to allow the server to respond to GETATTR      requests for a file which is the subject of an open delegation.      If the handle specified is not one for which the client holds a      write open delegation, an NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE error is returned.   IMPLEMENTATION      The client returns attrbits and the associated attribute values      only for attributes that it may change (change, time_modify,      object_size).   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE15.2.2.  Operation 4: CB_RECALL - Recall an Open Delegation   SYNOPSIS      stateid, truncate, fh -> status   ARGUMENT      struct CB_RECALL4args {              stateid4        stateid;              bool            truncate;              nfs_fh4         fh;      };   RESULT      struct CB_RECALL4res {              nfsstat4        status;      };   DESCRIPTION      The CB_RECALL operation is used to begin the process of recalling      an open delegation and returning it to the server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 173]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000      The truncate flag is used to optimize recall for a file which is      about to be truncated to zero.  When it is set, the client is      freed of obligation to propagate modified data for the file to the      server, since this data is irrelevant.      If the handle specified is not one for which the client holds an      open delegation, an NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE error is returned.      If the stateid specified is not one corresponding to an open      delegation for the file specified by the filehandle, an      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID is returned.   IMPLEMENTATION      The client should reply to the callback immediately.  Replying      does not complete the recall.  The recall is not complete until      the delegation is returned using a DELEGRETURN.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE16.  Security Considerations   The major security feature to consider is the authentication of the   user making the request of NFS service.  Consideration should also be   given to the integrity and privacy of this NFS request.  These   specific issues are discussed as part of the section on "RPC and   Security Flavor".17.  IANA Considerations17.1.  Named Attribute Definition   The NFS version 4 protocol provides for the association of named   attributes to files.  The name space identifiers for these attributes   are defined as string names.  The protocol does not define the   specific assignment of the name space for these file attributes; the   application developer or system vendor is allowed to define the   attribute, its semantics, and the associated name.  Even though this   name space will not be specifically controlled to prevent collisions,   the application developer or system vendor is strongly encouraged to   provide the name assignment and associated semantics for attributes   via an Informational RFC.  This will provide for interoperability   where common interests exist.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 174]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200018.  RPC definition file   /*    *  Copyright (C) The Internet Society (1998,1999,2000).    *  All Rights Reserved.    */   /*    *      nfs4_prot.x    *    */   %#pragma ident  "@(#)nfs4_prot.x        1.97    00/06/12"   /*    * Basic typedefs forRFC 1832 data type definitions    */   typedef int             int32_t;   typedef unsigned int    uint32_t;   typedef hyper           int64_t;   typedef unsigned hyper  uint64_t;   /*    * Sizes    */   const NFS4_FHSIZE               = 128;   const NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE        = 8;   /*    * File types    */   enum nfs_ftype4 {           NF4REG          = 1,    /* Regular File */           NF4DIR          = 2,    /* Directory */           NF4BLK          = 3,    /* Special File - block device */           NF4CHR          = 4,    /* Special File - character device */           NF4LNK          = 5,    /* Symbolic Link */           NF4SOCK         = 6,    /* Special File - socket */           NF4FIFO         = 7,    /* Special File - fifo */           NF4ATTRDIR      = 8,    /* Attribute Directory */           NF4NAMEDATTR    = 9     /* Named Attribute */   };   /*    * Error status    */   enum nfsstat4 {           NFS4_OK                 = 0,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 175]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           NFS4ERR_PERM            = 1,           NFS4ERR_NOENT           = 2,           NFS4ERR_IO              = 5,           NFS4ERR_NXIO            = 6,           NFS4ERR_ACCES           = 13,           NFS4ERR_EXIST           = 17,           NFS4ERR_XDEV            = 18,           NFS4ERR_NODEV           = 19,           NFS4ERR_NOTDIR          = 20,           NFS4ERR_ISDIR           = 21,           NFS4ERR_INVAL           = 22,           NFS4ERR_FBIG            = 27,           NFS4ERR_NOSPC           = 28,           NFS4ERR_ROFS            = 30,           NFS4ERR_MLINK           = 31,           NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG     = 63,           NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY        = 66,           NFS4ERR_DQUOT           = 69,           NFS4ERR_STALE           = 70,           NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE       = 10001,           NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE      = 10003,           NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP         = 10004,           NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL        = 10005,           NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT     = 10006,           NFS4ERR_BADTYPE         = 10007,           NFS4ERR_DELAY           = 10008,           NFS4ERR_SAME            = 10009,/* nverify says attrs same */           NFS4ERR_DENIED          = 10010,/* lock unavailable        */           NFS4ERR_EXPIRED         = 10011,/* lock lease expired      */           NFS4ERR_LOCKED          = 10012,/* I/O failed due to lock  */           NFS4ERR_GRACE           = 10013,/* in grace period         */           NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED       = 10014,/* file handle expired     */           NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED    = 10015,/* share reserve denied    */           NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC        = 10016,/* wrong security flavor   */           NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      = 10017,/* clientid in use         */           NFS4ERR_RESOURCE        = 10018,/* resource exhaustion     */           NFS4ERR_MOVED           = 10019,/* filesystem relocated    */           NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE    = 10020,/* current FH is not set   */           NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH = 10021,/* minor vers not supp */           NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID  = 10022,           NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID   = 10023,           NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID     = 10024,           NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID     = 10025,           NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID       = 10026,           NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME        = 10027,/* verify - attrs not same */           NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      = 10028,           NFS4ERR_SYMLINK         = 10029,           NFS4ERR_READDIR_NOSPC   = 10030,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 176]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED     = 10031   };   /*    * Basic data types    */   typedef uint32_t        bitmap4<>;   typedef uint64_t        offset4;   typedef uint32_t        count4;   typedef uint64_t        length4;   typedef uint64_t        clientid4;   typedef uint64_t        stateid4;   typedef uint32_t        seqid4;   typedef opaque          utf8string<>;   typedef utf8string      component4;   typedef component4      pathname4<>;   typedef uint64_t        nfs_lockid4;   typedef uint64_t        nfs_cookie4;   typedef utf8string      linktext4;   typedef opaque          sec_oid4<>;   typedef uint32_t        qop4;   typedef uint32_t        mode4;   typedef uint64_t        changeid4;   typedef opaque          verifier4[NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE];   /*    * Timeval    */   struct nfstime4 {           int64_t         seconds;           uint32_t        nseconds;   };   enum time_how4 {           SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4 = 0,           SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4 = 1   };   union settime4 switch (time_how4 set_it) {    case SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4:            nfstime4       time;    default:            void;   };   /*    * File access handle    */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 177]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   typedef opaque  nfs_fh4<NFS4_FHSIZE>;   /*    * File attribute definitions    */   /*    * FSID structure for major/minor    */   struct fsid4 {           uint64_t        major;           uint64_t        minor;   };   /*    * Filesystem locations attribute for relocation/migration    */   struct fs_location4 {           utf8string      server<>;           pathname4       rootpath;   };   struct fs_locations4 {           pathname4       fs_root;           fs_location4    locations<>;   };   /*    * Various Access Control Entry definitions    */   /*    * Mask that indicates which Access Control Entries are supported.    * Values for the fattr4_aclsupport attribute.    */   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALLOW_ACL    = 0x00000001;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_DENY_ACL     = 0x00000002;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_AUDIT_ACL    = 0x00000004;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALARM_ACL    = 0x00000008;   typedef uint32_t        acetype4;   /*    * acetype4 values, others can be added as needed.    */   const ACE4_ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE_TYPE      = 0x00000000;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 178]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   const ACE4_ACCESS_DENIED_ACE_TYPE       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000003;   /*    * ACE flag    */   typedef uint32_t aceflag4;   /*    * ACE flag values    */   const ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE             = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACE     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE             = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG       = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP             = 0x00000040;   /*    * ACE mask    */   typedef uint32_t        acemask4;   /*    * ACE mask values    */   const ACE4_READ_DATA            = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_LIST_DIRECTORY       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_WRITE_DATA           = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_ADD_FILE             = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_APPEND_DATA          = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_ADD_SUBDIRECTORY     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_READ_NAMED_ATTRS     = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS    = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_EXECUTE              = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_DELETE_CHILD         = 0x00000040;   const ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES      = 0x00000080;   const ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES     = 0x00000100;   const ACE4_DELETE               = 0x00010000;   const ACE4_READ_ACL             = 0x00020000;   const ACE4_WRITE_ACL            = 0x00040000;   const ACE4_WRITE_OWNER          = 0x00080000;   const ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE          = 0x00100000;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 179]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_READ -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL |    *      ACE4_READ_DATA |    *      ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES |    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_READ = 0x00120081;   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_WRITE -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL |    *      ACE4_WRITE_DATA |    *      ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES |    *      ACE4_WRITE_ACL |    *      ACE4_APPEND_DATA |    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_WRITE = 0x00160106;   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_EXECUTE -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL    *      ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES    *      ACE4_EXECUTE    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_EXECUTE = 0x001200A0;   /*    * Access Control Entry definition    */   struct nfsace4 {           acetype4        type;           aceflag4        flag;           acemask4        access_mask;           utf8string      who;   };   /*    * Special data/attribute associated with    * file types NF4BLK and NF4CHR.    */   struct specdata4 {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 180]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           uint32_t        specdata1;           uint32_t        specdata2;   };   /*    * Values for fattr4_fh_expire_type    */   const   FH4_PERSISTENT          = 0x00000000;   const   FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN  = 0x00000001;   const   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY        = 0x00000002;   const   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION       = 0x00000004;   const   FH4_VOL_RENAME          = 0x00000008;   typedef bitmap4         fattr4_supported_attrs;   typedef nfs_ftype4      fattr4_type;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_fh_expire_type;   typedef changeid4       fattr4_change;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_size;   typedef bool            fattr4_link_support;   typedef bool            fattr4_symlink_support;   typedef bool            fattr4_named_attr;   typedef fsid4           fattr4_fsid;   typedef bool            fattr4_unique_handles;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_lease_time;   typedef nfsstat4        fattr4_rdattr_error;   typedef nfsace4         fattr4_acl<>;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_aclsupport;   typedef bool            fattr4_archive;   typedef bool            fattr4_cansettime;   typedef bool            fattr4_case_insensitive;   typedef bool            fattr4_case_preserving;   typedef bool            fattr4_chown_restricted;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_fileid;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_avail;   typedef nfs_fh4         fattr4_filehandle;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_free;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_total;   typedef fs_locations4   fattr4_fs_locations;   typedef bool            fattr4_hidden;   typedef bool            fattr4_homogeneous;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxfilesize;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_maxlink;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_maxname;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxread;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxwrite;   typedef utf8string      fattr4_mimetype;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 181]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   typedef mode4           fattr4_mode;   typedef bool            fattr4_no_trunc;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_numlinks;   typedef utf8string      fattr4_owner;   typedef utf8string      fattr4_owner_group;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_avail_hard;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_avail_soft;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_used;   typedef specdata4       fattr4_rawdev;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_avail;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_free;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_total;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_used;   typedef bool            fattr4_system;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_access;   typedef settime4        fattr4_time_access_set;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_backup;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_create;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_delta;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_metadata;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_modify;   typedef settime4        fattr4_time_modify_set;   /*    * Mandatory Attributes    */   const FATTR4_SUPPORTED_ATTRS    = 0;   const FATTR4_TYPE               = 1;   const FATTR4_FH_EXPIRE_TYPE     = 2;   const FATTR4_CHANGE             = 3;   const FATTR4_SIZE               = 4;   const FATTR4_LINK_SUPPORT       = 5;   const FATTR4_SYMLINK_SUPPORT    = 6;   const FATTR4_NAMED_ATTR         = 7;   const FATTR4_FSID               = 8;   const FATTR4_UNIQUE_HANDLES     = 9;   const FATTR4_LEASE_TIME         = 10;   const FATTR4_RDATTR_ERROR       = 11;   /*    * Recommended Attributes    */   const FATTR4_ACL                = 12;   const FATTR4_ACLSUPPORT         = 13;   const FATTR4_ARCHIVE            = 14;   const FATTR4_CANSETTIME         = 15;   const FATTR4_CASE_INSENSITIVE   = 16;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 182]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   const FATTR4_CASE_PRESERVING    = 17;   const FATTR4_CHOWN_RESTRICTED   = 18;   const FATTR4_FILEHANDLE         = 19;   const FATTR4_FILEID             = 20;   const FATTR4_FILES_AVAIL        = 21;   const FATTR4_FILES_FREE         = 22;   const FATTR4_FILES_TOTAL        = 23;   const FATTR4_FS_LOCATIONS       = 24;   const FATTR4_HIDDEN             = 25;   const FATTR4_HOMOGENEOUS        = 26;   const FATTR4_MAXFILESIZE        = 27;   const FATTR4_MAXLINK            = 28;   const FATTR4_MAXNAME            = 29;   const FATTR4_MAXREAD            = 30;   const FATTR4_MAXWRITE           = 31;   const FATTR4_MIMETYPE           = 32;   const FATTR4_MODE               = 33;   const FATTR4_NO_TRUNC           = 34;   const FATTR4_NUMLINKS           = 35;   const FATTR4_OWNER              = 36;   const FATTR4_OWNER_GROUP        = 37;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_AVAIL_HARD   = 38;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_AVAIL_SOFT   = 39;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_USED         = 40;   const FATTR4_RAWDEV             = 41;   const FATTR4_SPACE_AVAIL        = 42;   const FATTR4_SPACE_FREE         = 43;   const FATTR4_SPACE_TOTAL        = 44;   const FATTR4_SPACE_USED         = 45;   const FATTR4_SYSTEM             = 46;   const FATTR4_TIME_ACCESS        = 47;   const FATTR4_TIME_ACCESS_SET    = 48;   const FATTR4_TIME_BACKUP        = 49;   const FATTR4_TIME_CREATE        = 50;   const FATTR4_TIME_DELTA         = 51;   const FATTR4_TIME_METADATA      = 52;   const FATTR4_TIME_MODIFY        = 53;   const FATTR4_TIME_MODIFY_SET    = 54;   typedef opaque  attrlist4<>;   /*    * File attribute container    */   struct fattr4 {           bitmap4         attrmask;           attrlist4       attr_vals;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 183]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   };   /*    * Change info for the client    */   struct change_info4 {           bool            atomic;           changeid4       before;           changeid4       after;   };   struct clientaddr4 {           /* see struct rpcb inRFC 1833 */           string r_netid<>;               /* network id */           string r_addr<>;                /* universal address */   };   /*    * Callback program info as provided by the client    */   struct cb_client4 {           unsigned int    cb_program;           clientaddr4     cb_location;   };   /*    * Client ID    */   struct nfs_client_id4 {           verifier4       verifier;           opaque          id<>;   };   struct nfs_lockowner4 {           clientid4       clientid;           opaque          owner<>;   };   enum nfs_lock_type4 {           READ_LT         = 1,           WRITE_LT        = 2,           READW_LT        = 3,    /* blocking read */           WRITEW_LT       = 4     /* blocking write */   };   /*    * ACCESS: Check access permission    */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 184]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   const ACCESS4_READ      = 0x00000001;   const ACCESS4_LOOKUP    = 0x00000002;   const ACCESS4_MODIFY    = 0x00000004;   const ACCESS4_EXTEND    = 0x00000008;   const ACCESS4_DELETE    = 0x00000010;   const ACCESS4_EXECUTE   = 0x00000020;   struct ACCESS4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           uint32_t        access;   };   struct ACCESS4resok {           uint32_t        supported;           uint32_t        access;   };   union ACCESS4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            ACCESS4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CLOSE: Close a file and release share locks    */   struct CLOSE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           seqid4          seqid;           stateid4        stateid;   };   union CLOSE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            stateid4       stateid;    default:            void;   };   /*    * COMMIT: Commit cached data on server to stable storage    */   struct COMMIT4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           offset4         offset;           count4          count;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 185]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   struct COMMIT4resok {           verifier4       writeverf;   };   union COMMIT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            COMMIT4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CREATE: Create a file    */   union createtype4 switch (nfs_ftype4 type) {    case NF4LNK:            linktext4      linkdata;    case NF4BLK:    case NF4CHR:            specdata4      devdata;    case NF4SOCK:    case NF4FIFO:    case NF4DIR:            void;   };   struct CREATE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory for creation */           component4      objname;           createtype4     objtype;   };   struct CREATE4resok {           change_info4     cinfo;   };   union CREATE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            CREATE4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * DELEGPURGE: Purge Delegations Awaiting Recovery    */   struct DELEGPURGE4args {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 186]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           clientid4       clientid;   };   struct DELEGPURGE4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * DELEGRETURN: Return a delegation    */   struct DELEGRETURN4args {           stateid4        stateid;   };   struct DELEGRETURN4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * GETATTR: Get file attributes    */   struct GETATTR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory or file */           bitmap4         attr_request;   };   struct GETATTR4resok {           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   union GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            GETATTR4resok  resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * GETFH: Get current filehandle    */   struct GETFH4resok {           nfs_fh4         object;   };   union GETFH4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           GETFH4resok     resok4;    default:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 187]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           void;   };   /*    * LINK: Create link to an object    */   struct LINK4args {           /* SAVED_FH: source object */           /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */           component4      newname;   };   struct LINK4resok {           change_info4    cinfo;   };   union LINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            LINK4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * LOCK/LOCKT/LOCKU: Record lock management    */   struct LOCK4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           seqid4          seqid;           bool            reclaim;           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;   };   struct LOCK4denied {           nfs_lockowner4  owner;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;   };   union LOCK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            stateid4       stateid;    case NFS4ERR_DENIED:            LOCK4denied    denied;    default:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 188]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000            void;   };   struct LOCKT4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           nfs_lockowner4  owner;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;   };   union LOCKT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4ERR_DENIED:            LOCK4denied    denied;    case NFS4_OK:            void;    default:            void;   };   struct LOCKU4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           seqid4          seqid;           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;   };   union LOCKU4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case   NFS4_OK:            stateid4       stateid;    default:            void;   };   /*    * LOOKUP: Lookup filename    */   struct LOOKUP4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           pathname4       path;   };   struct LOOKUP4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           nfsstat4        status;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 189]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   /*    * LOOKUPP: Lookup parent directory    */   struct LOOKUPP4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * NVERIFY: Verify attributes different    */   struct NVERIFY4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   struct NVERIFY4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * Various definitions for OPEN    */   enum createmode4 {           UNCHECKED4      = 0,           GUARDED4        = 1,           EXCLUSIVE4      = 2   };   union createhow4 switch (createmode4 mode) {    case UNCHECKED4:    case GUARDED4:            fattr4         createattrs;    case EXCLUSIVE4:            verifier4      createverf;   };   enum opentype4 {           OPEN4_NOCREATE  = 0,           OPEN4_CREATE    = 1   };   union openflag4 switch (opentype4 opentype) {    case OPEN4_CREATE:            createhow4     how;    default:            void;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 190]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   /* Next definitions used for OPEN delegation */   enum limit_by4 {           NFS_LIMIT_SIZE          = 1,           NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS        = 2           /* others as needed */   };   struct nfs_modified_limit4 {           uint32_t        num_blocks;           uint32_t        bytes_per_block;   };   union nfs_space_limit4 switch (limit_by4 limitby) {    /* limit specified as file size */    case NFS_LIMIT_SIZE:            uint64_t               filesize;    /* limit specified by number of blocks */    case NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS:            nfs_modified_limit4    mod_blocks;   } ;   /*    * Share Access and Deny constants for open argument    */   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_READ   = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_WRITE  = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_BOTH   = 0x00000003;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_NONE     = 0x00000000;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_READ     = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE    = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH     = 0x00000003;   enum open_delegation_type4 {           OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE      = 0,           OPEN_DELEGATE_READ      = 1,           OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE     = 2   };   enum open_claim_type4 {           CLAIM_NULL              = 0,           CLAIM_PREVIOUS          = 1,           CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR      = 2,           CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV     = 3   };   struct open_claim_delegate_cur4 {           pathname4       file;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 191]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           stateid4        delegate_stateid;   };   union open_claim4 switch (open_claim_type4 claim) {    /*     * No special rights to file. Ordinary OPEN of the specified file.     */    case CLAIM_NULL:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           pathname4       file;    /*     * Right to the file established by an open previous to server     * reboot.  File identified by filehandle obtained at that time     * rather than by name.     */    case CLAIM_PREVIOUS:           /* CURRENT_FH: file being reclaimed */           uint32_t        delegate_type;    /*     * Right to file based on a delegation granted by the server.     * File is specified by name.     */    case CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           open_claim_delegate_cur4        delegate_cur_info;    /* Right to file based on a delegation granted to a previous boot     * instance of the client.  File is specified by name.     */    case CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV:            /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           pathname4       file_delegate_prev;   };   /*    * OPEN: Open a file, potentially receiving an open delegation    */   struct OPEN4args {           open_claim4     claim;           openflag4       openhow;           nfs_lockowner4  owner;           seqid4          seqid;           uint32_t        share_access;           uint32_t        share_deny;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 192]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   struct open_read_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call to                                              open for read */   };   struct open_write_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation */           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfs_space_limit4 space_limit;   /* Defines condition that                                              the client must check to                                              determine whether the                                              file needs to be flushed                                              to the server on close.                                              */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call as                                              part of a delegated                                              open. */   };   union open_delegation4   switch (open_delegation_type4 delegation_type) {           case OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE:                   void;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_READ:                   open_read_delegation4 read;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE:                   open_write_delegation4 write;   };   /*    * Result flags    */   /* Mandatory locking is in effect for this file. */   const OPEN4_RESULT_MLOCK        = 0x00000001;   /* Client must confirm open */   const OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM      = 0x00000002;   struct OPEN4resok {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 193]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for open */           change_info4    cinfo;          /* Directory Change Info */           uint32_t        rflags;         /* Result flags */           verifier4       open_confirm;   /* OPEN_CONFIRM verifier */           open_delegation4 delegation;    /* Info on any open                                              delegation */   };   union OPEN4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           OPEN4resok      resok4;    default:           void;   };   /*    * OPENATTR: open named attributes directory    */   struct OPENATTR4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: name attr directory*/           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * OPEN_CONFIRM: confirm the open    */   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           seqid4          seqid;           verifier4       open_confirm;   /* OPEN_CONFIRM verifier */   };   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4resok {           stateid4        stateid;   };   union OPEN_CONFIRM4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            OPEN_CONFIRM4resok     resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * OPEN_DOWNGRADE: downgrade the access/deny for a file    */   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 194]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           stateid4        stateid;           seqid4          seqid;           uint32_t        share_access;           uint32_t        share_deny;   };   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok {              stateid4        stateid;   };   union OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res switch(nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok    resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * PUTFH: Set current filehandle    */   struct PUTFH4args {           nfs_fh4         object;   };   struct PUTFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * PUTPUBFH: Set public filehandle    */   struct PUTPUBFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: public fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * PUTROOTFH: Set root filehandle    */   struct PUTROOTFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: root fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * READ: Read from fileShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 195]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000    */   struct READ4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           count4          count;   };   struct READ4resok {           bool            eof;           opaque          data<>;   };   union READ4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READ4resok     resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * READDIR: Read directory    */   struct READDIR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           nfs_cookie4     cookie;           verifier4       cookieverf;           count4          dircount;           count4          maxcount;           bitmap4         attr_request;   };   struct entry4 {           nfs_cookie4     cookie;           component4      name;           fattr4          attrs;           entry4          *nextentry;   };   struct dirlist4 {           entry4          *entries;           bool            eof;   };   struct READDIR4resok {           verifier4       cookieverf;           dirlist4        reply;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 196]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   union READDIR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READDIR4resok  resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * READLINK: Read symbolic link    */   struct READLINK4resok {           linktext4       link;   };   union READLINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READLINK4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * REMOVE: Remove filesystem object    */   struct REMOVE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      target;   };   struct REMOVE4resok {           change_info4    cinfo;   };   union REMOVE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            REMOVE4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * RENAME: Rename directory entry    */   struct RENAME4args {           /* SAVED_FH: source directory */           component4      oldname;           /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 197]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           component4      newname;   };   struct RENAME4resok {           change_info4    source_cinfo;           change_info4    target_cinfo;   };   union RENAME4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           RENAME4resok    resok4;    default:           void;   };   /*    * RENEW: Renew a Lease    */   struct RENEW4args {           stateid4        stateid;   };   struct RENEW4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * RESTOREFH: Restore saved filehandle    */   struct RESTOREFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: value of saved fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * SAVEFH: Save current filehandle    */   struct SAVEFH4res {           /* SAVED_FH: value of current fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * SECINFO: Obtain Available Security Mechanisms    */   struct SECINFO4args {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 198]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           /* CURRENT_FH: */           component4      name;   };   /*    * FromRFC 2203    */   enum rpc_gss_svc_t {           RPC_GSS_SVC_NONE        = 1,           RPC_GSS_SVC_INTEGRITY   = 2,           RPC_GSS_SVC_PRIVACY     = 3   };   struct rpcsec_gss_info {           sec_oid4        oid;           qop4            qop;           rpc_gss_svc_t   service;   };   struct secinfo4 {           uint32_t        flavor;           /* null for AUTH_SYS, AUTH_NONE;              contains rpcsec_gss_info for              RPCSEC_GSS. */           opaque          flavor_info<>;   };   typedef secinfo4 SECINFO4resok<>;   union SECINFO4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            SECINFO4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * SETATTR: Set attributes    */   struct SETATTR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: target object */           stateid4        stateid;           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   struct SETATTR4res {           nfsstat4        status;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 199]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           bitmap4         attrsset;   };   /*    * SETCLIENTID    */   struct SETCLIENTID4args {           nfs_client_id4  client;           cb_client4      callback;   };   struct SETCLIENTID4resok {           clientid4       clientid;           verifier4       setclientid_confirm;   };   union SETCLIENTID4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            SETCLIENTID4resok      resok4;    case NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE:            clientaddr4    client_using;    default:            void;   };   struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args {           verifier4       setclientid_confirm;   };   struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * VERIFY: Verify attributes same    */   struct VERIFY4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   struct VERIFY4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * WRITE: Write to file    */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 200]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   enum stable_how4 {           UNSTABLE4       = 0,           DATA_SYNC4      = 1,           FILE_SYNC4      = 2   };   struct WRITE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           stable_how4     stable;           opaque          data<>;   };   struct WRITE4resok {           count4          count;           stable_how4     committed;           verifier4       writeverf;   };   union WRITE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            WRITE4resok    resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * Operation arrays    */   enum nfs_opnum4 {           OP_ACCESS               = 3,           OP_CLOSE                = 4,           OP_COMMIT               = 5,           OP_CREATE               = 6,           OP_DELEGPURGE           = 7,           OP_DELEGRETURN          = 8,           OP_GETATTR              = 9,           OP_GETFH                = 10,           OP_LINK                 = 11,           OP_LOCK                 = 12,           OP_LOCKT                = 13,           OP_LOCKU                = 14,           OP_LOOKUP               = 15,           OP_LOOKUPP              = 16,           OP_NVERIFY              = 17,           OP_OPEN                 = 18,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 201]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           OP_OPENATTR             = 19,           OP_OPEN_CONFIRM         = 20,           OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE       = 21,           OP_PUTFH                = 22,           OP_PUTPUBFH             = 23,           OP_PUTROOTFH            = 24,           OP_READ                 = 25,           OP_READDIR              = 26,           OP_READLINK             = 27,           OP_REMOVE               = 28,           OP_RENAME               = 29,           OP_RENEW                = 30,           OP_RESTOREFH            = 31,           OP_SAVEFH               = 32,           OP_SECINFO              = 33,           OP_SETATTR              = 34,           OP_SETCLIENTID          = 35,           OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM  = 36,           OP_VERIFY               = 37,           OP_WRITE                = 38   };   union nfs_argop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 argop) {    case OP_ACCESS:        ACCESS4args opaccess;    case OP_CLOSE:         CLOSE4args opclose;    case OP_COMMIT:        COMMIT4args opcommit;    case OP_CREATE:        CREATE4args opcreate;    case OP_DELEGPURGE:    DELEGPURGE4args opdelegpurge;    case OP_DELEGRETURN:   DELEGRETURN4args opdelegreturn;    case OP_GETATTR:       GETATTR4args opgetattr;    case OP_GETFH:         void;    case OP_LINK:          LINK4args oplink;    case OP_LOCK:          LOCK4args oplock;    case OP_LOCKT:         LOCKT4args oplockt;    case OP_LOCKU:         LOCKU4args oplocku;    case OP_LOOKUP:        LOOKUP4args oplookup;    case OP_LOOKUPP:       void;    case OP_NVERIFY:       NVERIFY4args opnverify;    case OP_OPEN:          OPEN4args opopen;    case OP_OPENATTR:      void;    case OP_OPEN_CONFIRM:  OPEN_CONFIRM4args opopen_confirm;    case OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE:        OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args opopen_downgrade;    case OP_PUTFH:         PUTFH4args opputfh;    case OP_PUTPUBFH:      void;    case OP_PUTROOTFH:     void;    case OP_READ:          READ4args opread;    case OP_READDIR:       READDIR4args opreaddir;    case OP_READLINK:      void;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 202]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000    case OP_REMOVE:        REMOVE4args opremove;    case OP_RENAME:        RENAME4args oprename;    case OP_RENEW:         RENEW4args oprenew;    case OP_RESTOREFH:     void;    case OP_SAVEFH:        void;    case OP_SECINFO:       SECINFO4args opsecinfo;    case OP_SETATTR:       SETATTR4args opsetattr;    case OP_SETCLIENTID:   SETCLIENTID4args opsetclientid;    case OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM:   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args                                           opsetclientid_confirm;    case OP_VERIFY:        VERIFY4args opverify;    case OP_WRITE:         WRITE4args opwrite;   };   union nfs_resop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 resop){    case OP_ACCESS:        ACCESS4res opaccess;    case OP_CLOSE:         CLOSE4res opclose;    case OP_COMMIT:        COMMIT4res opcommit;    case OP_CREATE:        CREATE4res opcreate;    case OP_DELEGPURGE:    DELEGPURGE4res opdelegpurge;    case OP_DELEGRETURN:   DELEGRETURN4res opdelegreturn;    case OP_GETATTR:       GETATTR4res opgetattr;    case OP_GETFH:         GETFH4res opgetfh;    case OP_LINK:          LINK4res oplink;    case OP_LOCK:          LOCK4res oplock;    case OP_LOCKT:         LOCKT4res oplockt;    case OP_LOCKU:         LOCKU4res oplocku;    case OP_LOOKUP:        LOOKUP4res oplookup;    case OP_LOOKUPP:       LOOKUPP4res oplookupp;    case OP_NVERIFY:       NVERIFY4res opnverify;    case OP_OPEN:          OPEN4res opopen;    case OP_OPENATTR:      OPENATTR4res opopenattr;    case OP_OPEN_CONFIRM:  OPEN_CONFIRM4res opopen_confirm;    case OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE:        OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res opopen_downgrade;    case OP_PUTFH:         PUTFH4res opputfh;    case OP_PUTPUBFH:      PUTPUBFH4res opputpubfh;    case OP_PUTROOTFH:     PUTROOTFH4res opputrootfh;    case OP_READ:          READ4res opread;    case OP_READDIR:       READDIR4res opreaddir;    case OP_READLINK:      READLINK4res opreadlink;    case OP_REMOVE:        REMOVE4res opremove;    case OP_RENAME:        RENAME4res oprename;    case OP_RENEW:         RENEW4res oprenew;    case OP_RESTOREFH:     RESTOREFH4res oprestorefh;    case OP_SAVEFH:        SAVEFH4res opsavefh;    case OP_SECINFO:       SECINFO4res opsecinfo;    case OP_SETATTR:       SETATTR4res opsetattr;    case OP_SETCLIENTID:   SETCLIENTID4res opsetclientid;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 203]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000    case OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM:   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res                                           opsetclientid_confirm;    case OP_VERIFY:        VERIFY4res opverify;    case OP_WRITE:         WRITE4res opwrite;   };   struct COMPOUND4args {           utf8string      tag;           uint32_t        minorversion;           nfs_argop4      argarray<>;   };   struct COMPOUND4res {           nfsstat4 status;           utf8string      tag;           nfs_resop4      resarray<>;   };   /*    * Remote file service routines    */   program NFS4_PROGRAM {           version NFS_V4 {                   void                           NFSPROC4_NULL(void) = 0;                   COMPOUND4res                           NFSPROC4_COMPOUND(COMPOUND4args) = 1;           } = 4;   } = 100003;   /*    * NFS4 Callback Procedure Definitions and Program    */   /*    * CB_GETATTR: Get Current Attributes    */   struct CB_GETATTR4args {           nfs_fh4 fh;           bitmap4 attr_request;   };   struct CB_GETATTR4resok {           fattr4  obj_attributes;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 204]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   };   union CB_GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            CB_GETATTR4resok       resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CB_RECALL: Recall an Open Delegation    */   struct CB_RECALL4args {           stateid4        stateid;           bool            truncate;           nfs_fh4         fh;   };   struct CB_RECALL4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * Various definitions for CB_COMPOUND    */   enum nfs_cb_opnum4 {           OP_CB_GETATTR           = 3,           OP_CB_RECALL            = 4   };   union nfs_cb_argop4 switch (unsigned argop) {    case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4args opcbgetattr;    case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4args  opcbrecall;   };   union nfs_cb_resop4 switch (unsigned resop){    case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4res  opcbgetattr;    case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4res   opcbrecall;   };   struct CB_COMPOUND4args {           utf8string      tag;           uint32_t        minorversion;           nfs_cb_argop4   argarray<>;   };   struct CB_COMPOUND4res {           nfsstat4 status;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 205]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000           utf8string      tag;           nfs_cb_resop4   resarray<>;   };   /*    * Program number is in the transient range since the client    * will assign the exact transient program number and provide    * that to the server via the SETCLIENTID operation.    */   program NFS4_CALLBACK {           version NFS_CB {                   void                           CB_NULL(void) = 0;                   CB_COMPOUND4res                           CB_COMPOUND(CB_COMPOUND4args) = 1;           } = 1;   } = 40000000;19.  Bibliography   [Floyd]      S. Floyd, V. Jacobson, "The Synchronization of Periodic                Routing Messages," IEEE/ACM Transactions on Networking,                2(2), pp. 122-136, April 1994.   [Gray]       C. Gray, D. Cheriton, "Leases: An Efficient Fault-                Tolerant Mechanism for Distributed File Cache                Consistency," Proceedings of the Twelfth Symposium on                Operating Systems Principles, p. 202-210, December 1989.   [ISO10646]   "ISO/IEC 10646-1:1993. International Standard --                Information technology -- Universal Multiple-Octet Coded                Character Set (UCS) -- Part 1: Architecture and Basic                Multilingual Plane."   [Juszczak]   Juszczak, Chet, "Improving the Performance and                Correctness of an NFS Server," USENIX Conference                Proceedings, USENIX Association, Berkeley, CA, June                1990, pages 53-63.  Describes reply cache implementation                that avoids work in the server by handling duplicate                requests. More important, though listed as a side-                effect, the reply cache aids in the avoidance of                destructive non-idempotent operation re-application --                improving correctness.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 206]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   [Kazar]      Kazar, Michael Leon, "Synchronization and Caching Issues                in the Andrew File System," USENIX Conference                Proceedings, USENIX Association, Berkeley, CA, Dallas                Winter 1988, pages 27-36.  A description of the cache                consistency scheme in AFS.  Contrasted with other                distributed file systems.   [Macklem]    Macklem, Rick, "Lessons Learned Tuning the 4.3BSD Reno                Implementation of the NFS Protocol," Winter USENIX                Conference Proceedings, USENIX Association, Berkeley,                CA, January 1991.  Describes performance work in tuning                the 4.3BSD Reno NFS implementation. Describes                performance improvement (reduced CPU loading) through                elimination of data copies.   [Mogul]      Mogul, Jeffrey C., "A Recovery Protocol for Spritely                NFS," USENIX File System Workshop Proceedings, Ann                Arbor, MI, USENIX Association, Berkeley, CA, May 1992.                Second paper on Spritely NFS proposes a lease-based                scheme for recovering state of consistency protocol.   [Nowicki]    Nowicki, Bill, "Transport Issues in the Network File                System," ACM SIGCOMM newsletter Computer Communication                Review, April 1989.  A brief description of the basis                for the dynamic retransmission work.   [Pawlowski]  Pawlowski, Brian, Ron Hixon, Mark Stein, Joseph                Tumminaro, "Network Computing in the UNIX and IBM                Mainframe Environment," Uniforum `89 Conf.  Proc.,                (1989) Description of an NFS server implementation for                IBM's MVS operating system.   [RFC1094]    Sun Microsystems, Inc., "NFS: Network File System                Protocol Specification",RFC 1094, March 1989.   [RFC1345]    Simonsen, K., "Character Mnemonics & Character Sets",RFC 1345, June 1992.   [RFC1700]    Reynolds, J. and J. Postel, "Assigned Numbers", STD 2,RFC 1700, October 1994.   [RFC1813]    Callaghan, B., Pawlowski, B. and P. Staubach, "NFS                Version 3 Protocol Specification",RFC 1813, June 1995.   [RFC1831]    Srinivasan, R., "RPC: Remote Procedure Call Protocol                Specification Version 2",RFC 1831, August 1995.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 207]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   [RFC1832]    Srinivasan, R., "XDR: External Data Representation                Standard",RFC 1832, August 1995.   [RFC1833]    Srinivasan, R., "Binding Protocols for ONC RPC Version                2",RFC 1833, August 1995.   [RFC2025]    Adams, C., "The Simple Public-Key GSS-API Mechanism                (SPKM)",RFC 2025, October 1996.   [RFC2054]    Callaghan, B., "WebNFS Client Specification",RFC 2054,                October 1996.   [RFC2055]    Callaghan, B., "WebNFS Server Specification",RFC 2055,                October 1996.   [RFC2078]    Linn, J., "Generic Security Service Application Program                Interface, Version 2",RFC 2078, January 1997.   [RFC2152]    Goldsmith, D., "UTF-7 A Mail-Safe Transformation Format                of Unicode",RFC 2152, May 1997.   [RFC2203]    Eisler, M., Chiu, A. and L. Ling, "RPCSEC_GSS Protocol                Specification",RFC 2203, August 1995.   [RFC2277]    Alvestrand, H., "IETF Policy on Character Sets and                Languages",BCP 18,RFC 2277, January 1998.   [RFC2279]    Yergeau, F., "UTF-8, a transformation format of ISO                10646",RFC 2279, January 1998.   [RFC2623]    Eisler, M., "NFS Version 2 and Version 3 Security Issues                and the NFS Protocol's Use of RPCSEC_GSS and Kerberos                V5",RFC 2623, June 1999.   [RFC2624]    Shepler, S., "NFS Version 4 Design Considerations",RFC2624, June 1999.   [RFC2847]    Eisler, M., "LIPKEY - A Low Infrastructure Public Key                Mechanism Using SPKM",RFC 2847, June 2000.   [Sandberg]   Sandberg, R., D. Goldberg, S. Kleiman, D. Walsh, B.                Lyon, "Design and Implementation of the Sun Network                Filesystem," USENIX Conference Proceedings, USENIX                Association, Berkeley, CA, Summer 1985.  The basic paper                describing the SunOS implementation of the NFS version 2                protocol, and discusses the goals, protocol                specification and trade-offs.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 208]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   [Srinivasan] Srinivasan, V., Jeffrey C. Mogul, "Spritely NFS:                Implementation and Performance of Cache Consistency                Protocols", WRL Research Report 89/5, Digital Equipment                Corporation Western Research Laboratory, 100 Hamilton                Ave., Palo Alto, CA, 94301, May 1989.  This paper                analyzes the effect of applying a Sprite-like                consistency protocol applied to standard NFS. The issues                of recovery in a stateful environment are covered in                [Mogul].   [Unicode1]   The Unicode Consortium, "The Unicode Standard, Version                3.0", Addison-Wesley Developers Press, Reading, MA,                2000. ISBN 0-201-61633-5.                More information available at:http://www.unicode.org/   [Unicode2]   "Unsupported Scripts" Unicode, Inc., The Unicode                Consortium, P.O. Box 700519, San Jose, CA 95710-0519                USA, September 1999http://www.unicode.org/unicode/standard/unsupported.html   [XNFS]       The Open Group, Protocols for Interworking: XNFS,                Version 3W, The Open Group, 1010 El Camino Real Suite                380, Menlo Park, CA 94025, ISBN 1-85912-184-5, February                1998.                HTML version available:http://www.opengroup.orgShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 209]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200020.  Authors20.1.  Editor's Address   Spencer Shepler   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   7808 Moonflower Drive   Austin, Texas 78750   Phone: +1 512-349-9376   EMail: spencer.shepler@sun.com20.2.  Authors' Addresses   Carl Beame   Hummingbird Ltd.   EMail: beame@bws.com   Brent Callaghan   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   901 San Antonio Road   Palo Alto, CA 94303   Phone: +1 650-786-5067   EMail: brent.callaghan@sun.com   Mike Eisler   5565 Wilson Road   Colorado Springs, CO 80919   Phone: +1 719-599-9026   EMail: mike@eisler.com   David Noveck   Network Appliance   375 Totten Pond Road   Waltham, MA  02451   Phone: +1 781-895-4949   E-mail: dnoveck@netapp.comShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 210]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 2000   David Robinson   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   901 San Antonio Road   Palo Alto, CA 94303   Phone: +1 650-786-5088   EMail: david.robinson@sun.com   Robert Thurlow   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   901 San Antonio Road   Palo Alto, CA 94303   Phone: +1 650-786-5096   EMail: robert.thurlow@sun.com20.3.  Acknowledgements   The author thanks and acknowledges:   Neil Brown for his extensive review and comments of various drafts.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 211]

RFC 3010                 NFS version 4 Protocol            December 200021.  Full Copyright Statement   Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2000).  All Rights Reserved.   This document and translations of it may be copied and furnished to   others, and derivative works that comment on or otherwise explain it   or assist in its implementation may be prepared, copied, published   and distributed, in whole or in part, without restriction of any   kind, provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are   included on all such copies and derivative works.  However, this   document itself may not be modified in any way, such as by removing   the copyright notice or references to the Internet Society or other   Internet organizations, except as needed for the purpose of   developing Internet standards in which case the procedures for   copyrights defined in the Internet Standards process must be   followed, or as required to translate it into languages other than   English.   The limited permissions granted above are perpetual and will not be   revoked by the Internet Society or its successors or assigns.   This document and the information contained herein is provided on an   "AS IS" basis and THE INTERNET SOCIETY AND THE INTERNET ENGINEERING   TASK FORCE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTY THAT THE USE OF THE INFORMATION   HEREIN WILL NOT INFRINGE ANY RIGHTS OR ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF   MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.Acknowledgement   Funding for the RFC Editor function is currently provided by the   Internet Society.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 212]

[8]ページ先頭

©2009-2025 Movatter.jp